* config/m68k/m68k.md (bungt_rev): New pattern.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob54942235ec2d6e149f18ad21c03256d539bb0868
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83 CIE = Common Information Entry
84 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86 FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 how to restore registers
90 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
102 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
105 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107 #endif
109 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110 translation unit. */
113 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
115 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
118 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123 && (flag_unwind_tables
124 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125 #endif
129 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
130 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
131 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132 #endif
134 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135 must be kept around forever. */
136 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
138 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141 it. */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
144 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
148 define type declaration DIE's. */
149 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
151 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
163 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
164 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
165 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
166 #endif
168 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
169 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
170 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
172 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
173 Information instructions. The register number, offset
174 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
175 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
177 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
178 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
179 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
180 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
181 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
182 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
185 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
187 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
188 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
189 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
190 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
192 dw_cfi_oprnd;
194 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
196 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
197 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
198 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
199 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
200 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
201 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
203 dw_cfi_node;
205 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
206 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
207 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
208 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
209 of this structure. */
210 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
212 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
213 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
214 unsigned int reg;
215 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
216 } dw_cfa_location;
218 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
219 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
220 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
221 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
222 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
224 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
226 tree decl;
227 const char *dw_fde_begin;
228 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
229 const char *dw_fde_end;
230 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
231 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
232 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
233 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
234 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
235 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
236 unsigned funcdef_number;
237 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
238 unsigned nothrow : 1;
239 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
241 dw_fde_node;
243 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
244 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
246 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
247 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
248 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
249 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
250 pointers. */
251 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
252 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
253 #endif
255 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
256 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
257 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
258 as PTR_SIZE. */
260 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
261 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
262 #endif
264 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
265 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
266 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
267 bytes.
269 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
270 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
272 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
273 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
274 #endif
276 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
278 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
279 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
280 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
282 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
283 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
284 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
285 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
286 #else
287 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
288 #endif
289 #endif
291 /* CIE identifier. */
292 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
293 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
294 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
295 #else
296 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
297 #endif
299 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
300 information for each routine. */
301 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
303 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
304 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
306 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
307 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
309 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
310 fde_table. */
311 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
313 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
314 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
316 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
317 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
318 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
319 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
320 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
321 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
322 #endif
324 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
326 const char *str;
327 unsigned int refcount;
328 unsigned int form;
329 char *label;
332 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
334 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
335 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
337 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
339 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
341 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
342 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
343 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
344 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
345 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
346 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
347 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
348 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
349 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
350 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
351 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
352 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
353 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
354 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
355 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
356 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
358 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
359 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
360 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
361 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
362 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
363 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
364 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
366 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
367 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
368 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
369 #endif
371 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
372 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
373 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
375 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
376 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
377 #endif
379 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
380 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
381 #endif
383 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
384 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
385 #endif
387 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
388 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
389 #endif
390 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
391 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
392 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
393 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
394 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
395 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
396 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
397 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
398 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
399 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
401 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
402 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
403 registers. */
404 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
405 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
406 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
407 #else
408 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
409 #endif
410 #endif
412 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
413 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
414 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
415 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
416 #endif
418 /* Hook used by __throw. */
421 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
423 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
424 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
427 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
428 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
430 static inline char *
431 stripattributes (const char *s)
433 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
434 char *p = stripped;
436 *p++ = '*';
438 while (*s && *s != ',')
439 *p++ = *s++;
441 *p = '\0';
442 return stripped;
445 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
447 void
448 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
450 unsigned int i;
451 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
452 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
453 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
454 bool wrote_return_column = false;
456 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
458 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
460 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
462 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
463 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
464 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
466 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
467 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
468 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
470 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
471 continue;
472 wrote_return_column = true;
474 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
475 if (offset < 0)
476 continue;
478 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
479 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
483 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
484 gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
485 i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
486 wrote_return_column = false;
487 #else
488 i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
489 #endif
491 if (! wrote_return_column)
493 enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
494 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
495 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
496 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
500 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
502 static const char *
503 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
505 switch (cfi_opc)
507 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
508 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
509 case DW_CFA_offset:
510 return "DW_CFA_offset";
511 case DW_CFA_restore:
512 return "DW_CFA_restore";
513 case DW_CFA_nop:
514 return "DW_CFA_nop";
515 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
516 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
517 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
518 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
519 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
520 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
521 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
522 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
523 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
524 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
525 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
526 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
527 case DW_CFA_undefined:
528 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
529 case DW_CFA_same_value:
530 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
531 case DW_CFA_register:
532 return "DW_CFA_register";
533 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
534 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
535 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
536 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
537 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
538 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
539 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
540 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
541 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
542 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
544 /* DWARF 3 */
545 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
546 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
547 case DW_CFA_expression:
548 return "DW_CFA_expression";
549 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
550 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
551 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
552 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
553 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
554 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
556 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
557 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
558 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
560 /* GNU extensions */
561 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
562 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
563 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
564 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
565 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
566 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
568 default:
569 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
573 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
575 static inline dw_cfi_ref
576 new_cfi (void)
578 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
580 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
581 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
582 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
584 return cfi;
587 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
589 static inline void
590 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
592 dw_cfi_ref *p;
594 /* Find the end of the chain. */
595 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
598 *p = cfi;
601 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
603 char *
604 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
606 static char label[20];
608 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
609 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
610 return label;
613 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
614 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
616 static void
617 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
619 if (label)
621 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
623 if (*label == 0)
624 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
626 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
627 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
629 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
631 label = xstrdup (label);
633 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
634 xcfi = new_cfi ();
635 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
636 set the location directly using set_loc. */
637 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
638 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
639 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
640 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
641 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
643 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
646 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
649 else
650 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
653 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
655 static void
656 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
658 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
660 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
661 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
662 break;
663 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
664 loc->offset
665 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
666 break;
667 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
668 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
669 break;
670 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
671 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
672 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
673 break;
674 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
675 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
676 loc->offset
677 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
678 break;
679 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
680 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
681 break;
682 default:
683 break;
687 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
689 static void
690 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
692 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
694 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
695 loc->offset = 0;
696 loc->indirect = 0;
697 loc->base_offset = 0;
699 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
700 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
702 if (fde_table_in_use)
704 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
705 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
706 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
710 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
711 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
713 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
714 from the CFA. */
715 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
717 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
718 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
720 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
721 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
723 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
724 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
725 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
727 void
728 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
730 dw_cfa_location loc;
731 loc.indirect = 0;
732 loc.base_offset = 0;
733 loc.reg = reg;
734 loc.offset = offset;
735 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
738 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
740 static bool
741 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
743 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
744 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
745 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
746 && (loc1->indirect == 0
747 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
750 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
751 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
753 static void
754 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
756 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
757 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
759 cfa = *loc_p;
760 loc = *loc_p;
762 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
763 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
765 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
766 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
768 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
769 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
770 return;
772 cfi = new_cfi ();
774 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
776 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
777 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
778 if (loc.offset < 0)
780 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
781 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
783 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
784 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
786 else
788 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
789 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
793 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
794 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
795 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
796 && !loc.indirect)
798 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
799 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
800 offset has not changed. */
801 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
802 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
804 #endif
806 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
808 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
809 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
810 the specified offset. */
811 if (loc.offset < 0)
813 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
814 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
816 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
817 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
818 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
820 else
822 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
823 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
824 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
827 else
829 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
830 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
831 register-offset pair is available. */
832 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
834 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
835 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
836 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
839 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
842 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
843 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
844 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
845 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
847 static void
848 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
850 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
852 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
854 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
856 if (reg & ~0x3f)
857 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
858 the long form. */
859 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
860 else
861 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
863 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
865 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
866 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
867 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
868 description. */
869 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
871 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
873 #endif
874 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
875 if (offset < 0)
876 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
878 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
880 else if (sreg == reg)
881 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
882 else
884 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
885 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
888 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
891 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
892 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
893 from the previous frame's window save area.
895 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
896 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
898 void
899 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
901 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
903 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
904 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
907 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
908 pushed onto the stack. */
910 void
911 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
913 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
915 if (size == old_args_size)
916 return;
918 old_args_size = size;
920 cfi = new_cfi ();
921 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
922 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
923 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
926 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
927 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
929 void
930 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
932 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
935 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
936 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
938 void
939 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
941 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
944 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
945 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
947 void
948 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
950 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
953 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
954 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
956 static void
957 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
959 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
960 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
962 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
964 case REG:
965 /* RA is in a register. */
966 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
967 break;
969 case MEM:
970 /* RA is on the stack. */
971 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
972 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
974 case REG:
975 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
976 offset = 0;
977 break;
979 case PLUS:
980 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
981 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
982 break;
984 case MINUS:
985 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
986 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
987 break;
989 default:
990 gcc_unreachable ();
993 break;
995 case PLUS:
996 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
997 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
998 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
999 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1000 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1001 return;
1003 default:
1004 gcc_unreachable ();
1007 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1008 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1011 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1012 contains. */
1014 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1015 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1017 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1018 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1019 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1020 enum rtx_code code;
1022 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1024 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1025 code = GET_CODE (src);
1026 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1027 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1028 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1029 return 0;
1031 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1032 if (code == PLUS)
1033 offset = -offset;
1035 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1037 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1038 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1039 code = GET_CODE (src);
1041 switch (code)
1043 case PRE_MODIFY:
1044 case POST_MODIFY:
1045 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1047 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1048 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1049 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1050 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1051 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1052 break;
1054 return 0;
1056 case PRE_DEC:
1057 case POST_DEC:
1058 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1060 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1061 break;
1063 return 0;
1065 case PRE_INC:
1066 case POST_INC:
1067 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1069 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1070 break;
1072 return 0;
1074 default:
1075 return 0;
1078 else
1079 return 0;
1081 return offset;
1084 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1085 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1086 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1088 static void
1089 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1091 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1092 const char *label;
1093 int i;
1095 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1096 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1097 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1098 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1099 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1100 return;
1102 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1103 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1104 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1106 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1108 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1109 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1110 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1111 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1112 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1113 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1114 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1115 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1117 return;
1120 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1122 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1123 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1124 return;
1126 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1128 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1129 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1130 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1131 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1132 offset = -args_size;
1133 #else
1134 offset = args_size;
1135 #endif
1137 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1138 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1139 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1140 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1142 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1143 for them. */
1144 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1145 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1146 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1148 else
1149 return;
1151 if (offset == 0)
1152 return;
1154 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1155 cfa.offset += offset;
1157 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1158 offset = -offset;
1159 #endif
1161 args_size += offset;
1162 if (args_size < 0)
1163 args_size = 0;
1165 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1166 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1167 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1168 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1171 #endif
1173 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1174 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1175 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1177 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1179 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1180 rtx reg;
1181 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1182 rtx saved_reg;
1185 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1187 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1188 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1189 rtx orig_reg;
1190 rtx saved_in_reg;
1193 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1194 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1195 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1196 more efficient data structure. */
1197 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1198 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1200 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1201 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1203 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1204 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1206 static void
1207 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1209 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1211 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1212 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1213 order. */
1214 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1215 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1216 break;
1218 if (q == NULL)
1220 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1221 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1222 queued_reg_saves = q;
1225 q->reg = reg;
1226 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1227 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1229 last_reg_save_label = label;
1232 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1234 static void
1235 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1237 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1239 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1241 size_t i;
1242 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1244 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1245 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1246 break;
1247 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1249 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1250 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1252 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1254 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1255 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1258 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1259 if (q->saved_reg)
1260 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1261 else
1262 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1263 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1266 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1267 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1270 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1271 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1272 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1273 have a new location for? */
1275 static bool
1276 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1278 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1280 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1282 size_t i;
1283 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1284 return true;
1285 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1286 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1287 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1288 return true;
1291 return false;
1294 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1296 void
1297 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1299 size_t i;
1300 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1302 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1303 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1304 break;
1305 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1307 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1308 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1310 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1311 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1313 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1314 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1315 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1318 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1320 static rtx
1321 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1323 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1324 size_t i;
1325 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1327 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1328 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1329 return q->reg;
1331 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1332 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1333 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1334 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1336 return NULL_RTX;
1340 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1341 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1342 value, not an offset. */
1343 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1345 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1346 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1347 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1348 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1350 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1351 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1352 users need not read the source code.
1354 The High-Level Picture
1356 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1357 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1358 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1359 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1360 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1362 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1363 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1364 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1365 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1366 saves. This also seems to work.
1368 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1369 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1370 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1371 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1372 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1373 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1374 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1375 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1376 value as in the caller.
1378 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1379 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1380 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1381 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1383 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1384 register,
1386 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1388 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1389 consists of a register and an offset.
1390 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1391 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1392 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1393 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1394 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1395 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1396 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1398 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1399 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1400 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1401 cfa_temp.offset.
1403 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1404 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1405 and cfa_temp.offset.
1407 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1408 stack.
1410 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1411 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1412 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1414 The Rules
1416 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1417 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1419 Rule 1:
1420 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1421 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1422 cfa.offset unchanged
1423 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1424 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1426 Rule 2:
1427 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1428 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1429 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1430 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1431 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1432 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1434 Rule 3:
1435 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1436 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1437 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1439 Rule 4:
1440 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1441 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1442 <reg1> != sp
1443 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1444 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1445 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1447 Rule 5:
1448 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1449 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1450 <reg1> != sp
1451 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1452 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1454 Rule 6:
1455 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1456 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1457 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1459 Rule 7:
1460 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1461 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1462 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1464 Rule 8:
1465 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1466 effects: none
1468 Rule 9:
1469 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1470 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1471 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1473 Rule 10:
1474 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1475 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1476 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1477 cfa.reg = sp
1478 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1480 Rule 11:
1481 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1482 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1483 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1484 cfa.reg = sp
1485 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1487 Rule 12:
1488 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1490 <reg2>)
1491 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1492 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1494 Rule 13:
1495 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1496 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1497 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1499 Rule 14:
1500 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1501 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1502 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1503 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1505 Rule 15:
1506 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1507 effects: target-dependent */
1509 static void
1510 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1512 rtx src, dest;
1513 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1515 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1516 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1517 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1518 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1519 flag is set in them. */
1520 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1522 int par_index;
1523 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1525 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1526 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1527 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1528 || par_index == 0))
1529 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1531 return;
1534 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1536 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1537 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1539 if (REG_P (src))
1541 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1542 if (rsi)
1543 src = rsi;
1546 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1548 case REG:
1549 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1551 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1552 case REG:
1553 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1555 /* Rule 1 */
1556 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1557 relative to the current CFA register.
1559 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1560 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1561 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1562 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1563 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1564 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1565 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1567 else
1569 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1570 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1571 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1572 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1573 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1574 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1576 break;
1578 case PLUS:
1579 case MINUS:
1580 case LO_SUM:
1581 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1583 /* Rule 2 */
1584 /* Adjusting SP. */
1585 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1587 case CONST_INT:
1588 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1589 break;
1590 case REG:
1591 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1592 == cfa_temp.reg);
1593 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1594 break;
1595 default:
1596 gcc_unreachable ();
1599 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1601 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1602 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1603 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1605 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1606 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1608 else
1609 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1611 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1612 offset = -offset;
1613 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1614 cfa.offset += offset;
1615 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1616 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1618 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1620 /* Rule 3 */
1621 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1622 or adjusting the FP */
1623 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1625 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1626 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1627 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1628 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1629 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1630 offset = -offset;
1631 cfa.offset += offset;
1632 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1634 else
1636 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1638 /* Rule 4 */
1639 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1640 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1641 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1643 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1644 into the FP later on. */
1645 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1646 cfa.offset += offset;
1647 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1648 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1649 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1650 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1653 /* Rule 5 */
1654 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1655 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1656 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1658 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1659 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1660 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1661 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1662 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1665 /* Rule 9 */
1666 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1667 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1669 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1670 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1672 else
1673 gcc_unreachable ();
1675 break;
1677 /* Rule 6 */
1678 case CONST_INT:
1679 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1680 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1681 break;
1683 /* Rule 7 */
1684 case IOR:
1685 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1686 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1687 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1689 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1690 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1691 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1692 break;
1694 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1695 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1696 /* Rule 8 */
1697 case HIGH:
1698 break;
1700 /* Rule 15 */
1701 case UNSPEC:
1702 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1703 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1704 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1705 return;
1707 default:
1708 gcc_unreachable ();
1711 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1712 break;
1714 case MEM:
1715 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1717 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1718 CFA register. */
1719 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1721 /* Rule 10 */
1722 /* With a push. */
1723 case PRE_MODIFY:
1724 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1725 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1726 == CONST_INT);
1727 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1729 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1730 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1732 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1733 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1734 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1736 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1737 break;
1739 /* Rule 11 */
1740 case PRE_INC:
1741 case PRE_DEC:
1742 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1743 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1744 offset = -offset;
1746 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1747 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1749 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1750 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1751 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1753 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1754 break;
1756 /* Rule 12 */
1757 /* With an offset. */
1758 case PLUS:
1759 case MINUS:
1760 case LO_SUM:
1762 int regno;
1764 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1765 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1766 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1767 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1768 offset = -offset;
1770 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1772 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1773 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1774 else
1776 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1777 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1780 break;
1782 /* Rule 13 */
1783 /* Without an offset. */
1784 case REG:
1786 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1788 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1789 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1790 else
1792 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1793 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1796 break;
1798 /* Rule 14 */
1799 case POST_INC:
1800 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1801 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1802 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1803 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1804 break;
1806 default:
1807 gcc_unreachable ();
1810 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1811 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1812 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1814 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1816 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1818 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1819 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1820 on the ARM. */
1821 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1822 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1823 break;
1825 else
1827 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1828 calculate the CFA. */
1829 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1831 if (!REG_P (x))
1832 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1833 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1835 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1836 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1837 cfa.indirect = 1;
1838 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1839 break;
1843 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1844 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1845 break;
1847 default:
1848 gcc_unreachable ();
1852 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1853 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1854 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1856 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1857 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1859 void
1860 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1862 const char *label;
1863 rtx src;
1865 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1867 size_t i;
1869 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1870 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1872 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1873 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1874 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1875 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1877 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1878 cfa_store = cfa;
1879 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1880 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1882 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1884 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1885 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1887 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1888 return;
1891 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1892 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1894 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1896 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1897 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1898 return;
1901 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1902 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1903 if (src)
1904 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1905 else
1906 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1908 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1911 #endif
1913 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1914 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1915 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1917 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1918 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1920 switch (cfi)
1922 case DW_CFA_nop:
1923 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1924 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1926 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1927 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1928 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1929 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1930 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1931 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1933 case DW_CFA_offset:
1934 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1935 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1936 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1937 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1938 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1939 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1940 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1941 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1942 case DW_CFA_register:
1943 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1945 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1946 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1947 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1948 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1950 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1951 case DW_CFA_expression:
1952 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1954 default:
1955 gcc_unreachable ();
1959 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1960 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1961 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1963 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1964 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1966 switch (cfi)
1968 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1969 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1970 case DW_CFA_offset:
1971 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1972 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1973 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1975 case DW_CFA_register:
1976 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1978 default:
1979 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1983 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1985 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1986 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1987 for collect2. */
1989 static void
1990 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1992 tree label;
1994 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1995 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1997 int flags;
1999 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2001 int fde_encoding;
2002 int per_encoding;
2003 int lsda_encoding;
2005 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2006 /*global=*/0);
2007 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2008 /*global=*/1);
2009 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2010 /*global=*/0);
2011 flags = ((! flag_pic
2012 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2013 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2014 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2015 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2016 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2017 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2018 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2020 else
2021 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2022 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2024 #endif
2026 if (eh_frame_section)
2027 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2028 else
2030 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2031 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2032 switch_to_section (data_section);
2033 label = get_file_function_name ('F');
2034 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2035 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2036 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2037 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2041 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2043 static void
2044 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2046 unsigned long r;
2047 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2048 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2049 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2050 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2051 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2052 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2054 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2055 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2056 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2057 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2059 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2061 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2062 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2063 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2065 else
2067 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2068 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2070 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2072 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2073 if (for_eh)
2074 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2075 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2076 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2077 false, NULL);
2078 else
2079 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2080 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2081 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2082 break;
2084 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2085 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2086 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2087 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2088 break;
2090 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2091 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2092 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2093 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2094 break;
2096 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2097 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2098 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2099 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2100 break;
2102 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2103 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2104 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2105 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2106 break;
2108 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2109 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2110 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2111 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2112 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2113 break;
2115 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2116 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2117 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2118 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2119 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2120 break;
2122 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2123 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2124 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2125 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2126 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2127 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2128 break;
2130 case DW_CFA_register:
2131 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2132 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2133 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2134 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2135 break;
2137 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2138 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2139 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2140 break;
2142 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2143 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2144 break;
2146 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2147 break;
2149 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2150 case DW_CFA_expression:
2151 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2152 break;
2154 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2155 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2156 gcc_unreachable ();
2158 default:
2159 break;
2164 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2165 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2166 location of saved registers. */
2168 static void
2169 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2171 unsigned int i;
2172 dw_fde_ref fde;
2173 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2174 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2175 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2176 char augmentation[6];
2177 int augmentation_size;
2178 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2179 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2180 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2181 int return_reg;
2183 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2184 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2185 return;
2187 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2188 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2189 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2190 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2191 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2192 specialization doesn't. */
2193 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2194 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2195 && for_eh)
2196 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2197 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2198 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2199 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2200 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2201 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2203 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2204 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2205 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2206 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2207 if (for_eh)
2209 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2211 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2212 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2213 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2214 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2215 any_eh_needed = true;
2216 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2217 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2218 any_eh_needed = true;
2220 if (! any_eh_needed)
2221 return;
2224 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2225 if (flag_debug_asm)
2226 app_enable ();
2228 if (for_eh)
2229 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2230 else
2232 if (!debug_frame_section)
2233 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2234 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2235 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2238 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2239 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2241 /* Output the CIE. */
2242 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2243 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2244 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2245 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2246 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2247 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2248 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2249 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2251 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2252 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2253 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2254 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2255 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2257 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2259 augmentation[0] = 0;
2260 augmentation_size = 0;
2261 if (for_eh)
2263 char *p;
2265 /* Augmentation:
2266 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2267 augmentation section.
2268 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2269 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2270 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2271 FDE code pointers.
2272 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2273 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2275 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2276 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2277 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2279 p = augmentation + 1;
2280 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2282 *p++ = 'P';
2283 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2285 if (any_lsda_needed)
2287 *p++ = 'L';
2288 augmentation_size += 1;
2290 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2292 *p++ = 'R';
2293 augmentation_size += 1;
2295 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2297 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2298 *p = '\0';
2301 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2302 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2304 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2305 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2306 + 1 /* CIE version */
2307 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2308 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2309 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2310 + 1 /* RA column */
2311 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2312 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2313 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2315 augmentation_size += pad;
2317 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2318 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2319 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2323 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2324 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2325 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2326 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2328 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2329 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2330 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2331 else
2332 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2334 if (augmentation[0])
2336 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2337 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2339 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2340 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2341 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2342 eh_personality_libfunc,
2343 true, NULL);
2346 if (any_lsda_needed)
2347 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2348 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2350 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2351 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2352 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2355 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2356 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2358 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2359 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2360 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2361 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2363 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2364 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2366 fde = &fde_table[i];
2368 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2369 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2370 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2371 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2372 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2373 continue;
2375 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2376 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2377 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2378 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2379 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2380 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2381 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2382 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2383 "FDE Length");
2384 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2386 if (for_eh)
2387 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2388 else
2389 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2390 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2392 if (for_eh)
2394 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2395 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2396 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2397 sym_ref,
2398 false,
2399 "FDE initial location");
2400 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2402 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2403 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2404 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2405 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2406 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2407 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2408 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2409 "FDE initial location");
2410 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2411 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2412 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2413 "FDE address range");
2414 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2415 "FDE initial location");
2416 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2417 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2418 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2419 "FDE address range");
2421 else
2422 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2423 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2424 "FDE address range");
2426 else
2428 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2429 "FDE initial location");
2430 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2432 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2433 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2434 "FDE initial location");
2435 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2436 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2437 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2438 "FDE address range");
2439 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2440 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2441 "FDE initial location");
2442 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2443 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2444 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2445 "FDE address range");
2447 else
2448 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2449 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2450 "FDE address range");
2453 if (augmentation[0])
2455 if (any_lsda_needed)
2457 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2459 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2461 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2462 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2463 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2464 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2465 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2467 size += pad;
2468 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2471 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2473 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2475 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2476 fde->funcdef_number);
2477 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2478 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2479 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2481 else
2483 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2484 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2485 dw2_asm_output_data
2486 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2487 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2490 else
2491 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2494 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2495 this FDE. */
2496 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2497 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2498 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2500 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2501 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2502 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2503 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2506 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2507 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2508 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2509 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2510 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2511 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2512 #endif
2514 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2515 if (flag_debug_asm)
2516 app_disable ();
2519 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2520 the prologue. */
2522 void
2523 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2524 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2526 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2527 char * dup_label;
2528 dw_fde_ref fde;
2530 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2532 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2533 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2534 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2535 be used. */
2536 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2537 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2538 return;
2539 #else
2540 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2541 return;
2542 #endif
2544 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2545 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2546 current_function_funcdef_no);
2547 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2548 current_function_funcdef_no);
2549 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2550 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2552 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2553 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2554 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2555 return;
2556 #endif
2558 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2559 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2561 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2562 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2563 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2564 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2565 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2568 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2569 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2571 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2572 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2573 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2574 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2575 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2576 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2577 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2578 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2579 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2580 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2581 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2582 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2583 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2584 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2585 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2586 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2588 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2590 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2591 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2592 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2593 if (file)
2594 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2595 #endif
2598 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2599 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2600 been generated. */
2602 void
2603 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2604 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2606 dw_fde_ref fde;
2607 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2609 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2610 function. */
2611 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2612 current_function_funcdef_no);
2613 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2614 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2615 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2618 void
2619 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2621 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2622 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2623 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2624 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2626 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2627 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2629 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2630 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2632 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2633 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2634 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2635 #endif
2638 void
2639 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2641 /* Output call frame information. */
2642 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2643 output_call_frame_info (0);
2645 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2646 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2647 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2648 output_call_frame_info (1);
2649 #endif
2651 #endif
2653 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2654 for emitting location expressions. */
2656 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2657 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2658 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2661 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2662 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2663 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2664 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2666 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2667 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2668 implementation are listed below. */
2670 enum dw_val_class
2672 dw_val_class_addr,
2673 dw_val_class_offset,
2674 dw_val_class_loc,
2675 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2676 dw_val_class_range_list,
2677 dw_val_class_const,
2678 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2679 dw_val_class_long_long,
2680 dw_val_class_vec,
2681 dw_val_class_flag,
2682 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2683 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2684 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2685 dw_val_class_lineptr,
2686 dw_val_class_str,
2687 dw_val_class_macptr
2690 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2691 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2693 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2695 unsigned long hi;
2696 unsigned long low;
2698 dw_long_long_const;
2700 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2702 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2704 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2705 unsigned length;
2706 unsigned elt_size;
2708 dw_vec_const;
2710 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2711 represented internally. */
2713 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2715 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2716 union dw_val_struct_union
2718 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2719 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2720 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2721 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2722 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2723 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2724 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2725 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2726 struct dw_val_die_union
2728 dw_die_ref die;
2729 int external;
2730 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2731 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2732 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2733 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2734 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2736 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2738 dw_val_node;
2740 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2741 operations. */
2743 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2745 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2746 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2747 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2748 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2749 int dw_loc_addr;
2751 dw_loc_descr_node;
2753 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2754 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2755 their entire life. */
2756 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2758 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2759 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2760 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2761 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2762 Only on head of list */
2763 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2764 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2765 } dw_loc_list_node;
2767 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2769 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2770 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2771 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2772 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2773 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2774 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2775 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2776 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2778 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2780 static const char *
2781 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2783 switch (op)
2785 case DW_OP_addr:
2786 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2787 return "DW_OP_addr";
2788 case DW_OP_deref:
2789 return "DW_OP_deref";
2790 case DW_OP_const1u:
2791 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2792 case DW_OP_const1s:
2793 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2794 case DW_OP_const2u:
2795 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2796 case DW_OP_const2s:
2797 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2798 case DW_OP_const4u:
2799 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2800 case DW_OP_const4s:
2801 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2802 case DW_OP_const8u:
2803 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2804 case DW_OP_const8s:
2805 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2806 case DW_OP_constu:
2807 return "DW_OP_constu";
2808 case DW_OP_consts:
2809 return "DW_OP_consts";
2810 case DW_OP_dup:
2811 return "DW_OP_dup";
2812 case DW_OP_drop:
2813 return "DW_OP_drop";
2814 case DW_OP_over:
2815 return "DW_OP_over";
2816 case DW_OP_pick:
2817 return "DW_OP_pick";
2818 case DW_OP_swap:
2819 return "DW_OP_swap";
2820 case DW_OP_rot:
2821 return "DW_OP_rot";
2822 case DW_OP_xderef:
2823 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2824 case DW_OP_abs:
2825 return "DW_OP_abs";
2826 case DW_OP_and:
2827 return "DW_OP_and";
2828 case DW_OP_div:
2829 return "DW_OP_div";
2830 case DW_OP_minus:
2831 return "DW_OP_minus";
2832 case DW_OP_mod:
2833 return "DW_OP_mod";
2834 case DW_OP_mul:
2835 return "DW_OP_mul";
2836 case DW_OP_neg:
2837 return "DW_OP_neg";
2838 case DW_OP_not:
2839 return "DW_OP_not";
2840 case DW_OP_or:
2841 return "DW_OP_or";
2842 case DW_OP_plus:
2843 return "DW_OP_plus";
2844 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2845 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2846 case DW_OP_shl:
2847 return "DW_OP_shl";
2848 case DW_OP_shr:
2849 return "DW_OP_shr";
2850 case DW_OP_shra:
2851 return "DW_OP_shra";
2852 case DW_OP_xor:
2853 return "DW_OP_xor";
2854 case DW_OP_bra:
2855 return "DW_OP_bra";
2856 case DW_OP_eq:
2857 return "DW_OP_eq";
2858 case DW_OP_ge:
2859 return "DW_OP_ge";
2860 case DW_OP_gt:
2861 return "DW_OP_gt";
2862 case DW_OP_le:
2863 return "DW_OP_le";
2864 case DW_OP_lt:
2865 return "DW_OP_lt";
2866 case DW_OP_ne:
2867 return "DW_OP_ne";
2868 case DW_OP_skip:
2869 return "DW_OP_skip";
2870 case DW_OP_lit0:
2871 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2872 case DW_OP_lit1:
2873 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2874 case DW_OP_lit2:
2875 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2876 case DW_OP_lit3:
2877 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2878 case DW_OP_lit4:
2879 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2880 case DW_OP_lit5:
2881 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2882 case DW_OP_lit6:
2883 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2884 case DW_OP_lit7:
2885 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2886 case DW_OP_lit8:
2887 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2888 case DW_OP_lit9:
2889 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2890 case DW_OP_lit10:
2891 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2892 case DW_OP_lit11:
2893 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2894 case DW_OP_lit12:
2895 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2896 case DW_OP_lit13:
2897 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2898 case DW_OP_lit14:
2899 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2900 case DW_OP_lit15:
2901 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2902 case DW_OP_lit16:
2903 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2904 case DW_OP_lit17:
2905 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2906 case DW_OP_lit18:
2907 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2908 case DW_OP_lit19:
2909 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2910 case DW_OP_lit20:
2911 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2912 case DW_OP_lit21:
2913 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2914 case DW_OP_lit22:
2915 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2916 case DW_OP_lit23:
2917 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2918 case DW_OP_lit24:
2919 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2920 case DW_OP_lit25:
2921 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2922 case DW_OP_lit26:
2923 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2924 case DW_OP_lit27:
2925 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2926 case DW_OP_lit28:
2927 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2928 case DW_OP_lit29:
2929 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2930 case DW_OP_lit30:
2931 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2932 case DW_OP_lit31:
2933 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2934 case DW_OP_reg0:
2935 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2936 case DW_OP_reg1:
2937 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2938 case DW_OP_reg2:
2939 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2940 case DW_OP_reg3:
2941 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2942 case DW_OP_reg4:
2943 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2944 case DW_OP_reg5:
2945 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2946 case DW_OP_reg6:
2947 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2948 case DW_OP_reg7:
2949 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2950 case DW_OP_reg8:
2951 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2952 case DW_OP_reg9:
2953 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2954 case DW_OP_reg10:
2955 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2956 case DW_OP_reg11:
2957 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2958 case DW_OP_reg12:
2959 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2960 case DW_OP_reg13:
2961 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2962 case DW_OP_reg14:
2963 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2964 case DW_OP_reg15:
2965 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2966 case DW_OP_reg16:
2967 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2968 case DW_OP_reg17:
2969 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2970 case DW_OP_reg18:
2971 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2972 case DW_OP_reg19:
2973 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2974 case DW_OP_reg20:
2975 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2976 case DW_OP_reg21:
2977 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2978 case DW_OP_reg22:
2979 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2980 case DW_OP_reg23:
2981 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2982 case DW_OP_reg24:
2983 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2984 case DW_OP_reg25:
2985 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2986 case DW_OP_reg26:
2987 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2988 case DW_OP_reg27:
2989 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2990 case DW_OP_reg28:
2991 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2992 case DW_OP_reg29:
2993 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2994 case DW_OP_reg30:
2995 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2996 case DW_OP_reg31:
2997 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2998 case DW_OP_breg0:
2999 return "DW_OP_breg0";
3000 case DW_OP_breg1:
3001 return "DW_OP_breg1";
3002 case DW_OP_breg2:
3003 return "DW_OP_breg2";
3004 case DW_OP_breg3:
3005 return "DW_OP_breg3";
3006 case DW_OP_breg4:
3007 return "DW_OP_breg4";
3008 case DW_OP_breg5:
3009 return "DW_OP_breg5";
3010 case DW_OP_breg6:
3011 return "DW_OP_breg6";
3012 case DW_OP_breg7:
3013 return "DW_OP_breg7";
3014 case DW_OP_breg8:
3015 return "DW_OP_breg8";
3016 case DW_OP_breg9:
3017 return "DW_OP_breg9";
3018 case DW_OP_breg10:
3019 return "DW_OP_breg10";
3020 case DW_OP_breg11:
3021 return "DW_OP_breg11";
3022 case DW_OP_breg12:
3023 return "DW_OP_breg12";
3024 case DW_OP_breg13:
3025 return "DW_OP_breg13";
3026 case DW_OP_breg14:
3027 return "DW_OP_breg14";
3028 case DW_OP_breg15:
3029 return "DW_OP_breg15";
3030 case DW_OP_breg16:
3031 return "DW_OP_breg16";
3032 case DW_OP_breg17:
3033 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3034 case DW_OP_breg18:
3035 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3036 case DW_OP_breg19:
3037 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3038 case DW_OP_breg20:
3039 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3040 case DW_OP_breg21:
3041 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3042 case DW_OP_breg22:
3043 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3044 case DW_OP_breg23:
3045 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3046 case DW_OP_breg24:
3047 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3048 case DW_OP_breg25:
3049 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3050 case DW_OP_breg26:
3051 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3052 case DW_OP_breg27:
3053 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3054 case DW_OP_breg28:
3055 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3056 case DW_OP_breg29:
3057 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3058 case DW_OP_breg30:
3059 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3060 case DW_OP_breg31:
3061 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3062 case DW_OP_regx:
3063 return "DW_OP_regx";
3064 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3065 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3066 case DW_OP_bregx:
3067 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3068 case DW_OP_piece:
3069 return "DW_OP_piece";
3070 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3071 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3072 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3073 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3074 case DW_OP_nop:
3075 return "DW_OP_nop";
3076 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3077 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3078 case DW_OP_call2:
3079 return "DW_OP_call2";
3080 case DW_OP_call4:
3081 return "DW_OP_call4";
3082 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3083 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3084 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3085 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3086 default:
3087 return "OP_<unknown>";
3091 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3092 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3093 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3095 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3096 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3097 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3099 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3101 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3102 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3103 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3104 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3105 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3107 return descr;
3110 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3112 static inline void
3113 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3115 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3117 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3118 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3121 *d = descr;
3124 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3126 static unsigned long
3127 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3129 unsigned long size = 1;
3131 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3133 case DW_OP_addr:
3134 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3135 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3136 break;
3137 case DW_OP_const1u:
3138 case DW_OP_const1s:
3139 size += 1;
3140 break;
3141 case DW_OP_const2u:
3142 case DW_OP_const2s:
3143 size += 2;
3144 break;
3145 case DW_OP_const4u:
3146 case DW_OP_const4s:
3147 size += 4;
3148 break;
3149 case DW_OP_const8u:
3150 case DW_OP_const8s:
3151 size += 8;
3152 break;
3153 case DW_OP_constu:
3154 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3155 break;
3156 case DW_OP_consts:
3157 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3158 break;
3159 case DW_OP_pick:
3160 size += 1;
3161 break;
3162 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3163 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3164 break;
3165 case DW_OP_skip:
3166 case DW_OP_bra:
3167 size += 2;
3168 break;
3169 case DW_OP_breg0:
3170 case DW_OP_breg1:
3171 case DW_OP_breg2:
3172 case DW_OP_breg3:
3173 case DW_OP_breg4:
3174 case DW_OP_breg5:
3175 case DW_OP_breg6:
3176 case DW_OP_breg7:
3177 case DW_OP_breg8:
3178 case DW_OP_breg9:
3179 case DW_OP_breg10:
3180 case DW_OP_breg11:
3181 case DW_OP_breg12:
3182 case DW_OP_breg13:
3183 case DW_OP_breg14:
3184 case DW_OP_breg15:
3185 case DW_OP_breg16:
3186 case DW_OP_breg17:
3187 case DW_OP_breg18:
3188 case DW_OP_breg19:
3189 case DW_OP_breg20:
3190 case DW_OP_breg21:
3191 case DW_OP_breg22:
3192 case DW_OP_breg23:
3193 case DW_OP_breg24:
3194 case DW_OP_breg25:
3195 case DW_OP_breg26:
3196 case DW_OP_breg27:
3197 case DW_OP_breg28:
3198 case DW_OP_breg29:
3199 case DW_OP_breg30:
3200 case DW_OP_breg31:
3201 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3202 break;
3203 case DW_OP_regx:
3204 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3205 break;
3206 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3207 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3208 break;
3209 case DW_OP_bregx:
3210 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3211 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3212 break;
3213 case DW_OP_piece:
3214 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3215 break;
3216 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3217 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3218 size += 1;
3219 break;
3220 case DW_OP_call2:
3221 size += 2;
3222 break;
3223 case DW_OP_call4:
3224 size += 4;
3225 break;
3226 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3227 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3228 break;
3229 default:
3230 break;
3233 return size;
3236 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3238 static unsigned long
3239 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3241 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3242 unsigned long size;
3244 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3245 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
3246 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3248 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3249 break;
3250 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3252 if (! l)
3253 return size;
3255 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3257 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3258 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3261 return size;
3264 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3266 static void
3267 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3269 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3270 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3272 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3274 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3275 case DW_OP_addr:
3276 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3277 break;
3278 case DW_OP_const2u:
3279 case DW_OP_const2s:
3280 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3281 break;
3282 case DW_OP_const4u:
3283 case DW_OP_const4s:
3284 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3285 break;
3286 case DW_OP_const8u:
3287 case DW_OP_const8s:
3288 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3289 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3290 break;
3291 case DW_OP_skip:
3292 case DW_OP_bra:
3294 int offset;
3296 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3297 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3299 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3301 break;
3302 #else
3303 case DW_OP_addr:
3304 case DW_OP_const2u:
3305 case DW_OP_const2s:
3306 case DW_OP_const4u:
3307 case DW_OP_const4s:
3308 case DW_OP_const8u:
3309 case DW_OP_const8s:
3310 case DW_OP_skip:
3311 case DW_OP_bra:
3312 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3313 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3314 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3315 only doing unwinding. */
3316 gcc_unreachable ();
3317 #endif
3318 case DW_OP_const1u:
3319 case DW_OP_const1s:
3320 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3321 break;
3322 case DW_OP_constu:
3323 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3324 break;
3325 case DW_OP_consts:
3326 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3327 break;
3328 case DW_OP_pick:
3329 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3330 break;
3331 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3332 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3333 break;
3334 case DW_OP_breg0:
3335 case DW_OP_breg1:
3336 case DW_OP_breg2:
3337 case DW_OP_breg3:
3338 case DW_OP_breg4:
3339 case DW_OP_breg5:
3340 case DW_OP_breg6:
3341 case DW_OP_breg7:
3342 case DW_OP_breg8:
3343 case DW_OP_breg9:
3344 case DW_OP_breg10:
3345 case DW_OP_breg11:
3346 case DW_OP_breg12:
3347 case DW_OP_breg13:
3348 case DW_OP_breg14:
3349 case DW_OP_breg15:
3350 case DW_OP_breg16:
3351 case DW_OP_breg17:
3352 case DW_OP_breg18:
3353 case DW_OP_breg19:
3354 case DW_OP_breg20:
3355 case DW_OP_breg21:
3356 case DW_OP_breg22:
3357 case DW_OP_breg23:
3358 case DW_OP_breg24:
3359 case DW_OP_breg25:
3360 case DW_OP_breg26:
3361 case DW_OP_breg27:
3362 case DW_OP_breg28:
3363 case DW_OP_breg29:
3364 case DW_OP_breg30:
3365 case DW_OP_breg31:
3366 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3367 break;
3368 case DW_OP_regx:
3369 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3370 break;
3371 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3372 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3373 break;
3374 case DW_OP_bregx:
3375 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3376 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3377 break;
3378 case DW_OP_piece:
3379 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3380 break;
3381 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3382 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3383 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3384 break;
3386 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3387 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3389 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3390 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3391 val1->v.val_addr);
3392 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3394 else
3395 gcc_unreachable ();
3396 break;
3398 default:
3399 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3400 break;
3404 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3406 static void
3407 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3409 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3411 /* Output the opcode. */
3412 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3413 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3415 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3416 output_loc_operands (loc);
3420 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3421 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3423 static void
3424 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3426 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3427 unsigned long size;
3429 /* Output the size of the block. */
3430 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3431 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3432 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3434 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3435 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3438 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3439 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3440 expression. */
3442 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3443 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3445 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3447 offset += cfa->offset;
3449 if (cfa->indirect)
3451 if (cfa->base_offset)
3453 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3454 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3455 else
3456 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3458 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3459 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3460 else
3461 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3463 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3464 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3465 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3466 if (offset != 0)
3468 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3469 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3472 else
3474 if (offset == 0)
3475 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3476 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3477 else
3478 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3479 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3480 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3481 else
3482 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3485 return head;
3488 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3489 descriptor sequence. */
3491 static void
3492 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3494 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3495 cfa->offset = 0;
3496 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3497 cfa->indirect = 0;
3498 cfa->reg = -1;
3500 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3502 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3504 switch (op)
3506 case DW_OP_reg0:
3507 case DW_OP_reg1:
3508 case DW_OP_reg2:
3509 case DW_OP_reg3:
3510 case DW_OP_reg4:
3511 case DW_OP_reg5:
3512 case DW_OP_reg6:
3513 case DW_OP_reg7:
3514 case DW_OP_reg8:
3515 case DW_OP_reg9:
3516 case DW_OP_reg10:
3517 case DW_OP_reg11:
3518 case DW_OP_reg12:
3519 case DW_OP_reg13:
3520 case DW_OP_reg14:
3521 case DW_OP_reg15:
3522 case DW_OP_reg16:
3523 case DW_OP_reg17:
3524 case DW_OP_reg18:
3525 case DW_OP_reg19:
3526 case DW_OP_reg20:
3527 case DW_OP_reg21:
3528 case DW_OP_reg22:
3529 case DW_OP_reg23:
3530 case DW_OP_reg24:
3531 case DW_OP_reg25:
3532 case DW_OP_reg26:
3533 case DW_OP_reg27:
3534 case DW_OP_reg28:
3535 case DW_OP_reg29:
3536 case DW_OP_reg30:
3537 case DW_OP_reg31:
3538 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3539 break;
3540 case DW_OP_regx:
3541 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3542 break;
3543 case DW_OP_breg0:
3544 case DW_OP_breg1:
3545 case DW_OP_breg2:
3546 case DW_OP_breg3:
3547 case DW_OP_breg4:
3548 case DW_OP_breg5:
3549 case DW_OP_breg6:
3550 case DW_OP_breg7:
3551 case DW_OP_breg8:
3552 case DW_OP_breg9:
3553 case DW_OP_breg10:
3554 case DW_OP_breg11:
3555 case DW_OP_breg12:
3556 case DW_OP_breg13:
3557 case DW_OP_breg14:
3558 case DW_OP_breg15:
3559 case DW_OP_breg16:
3560 case DW_OP_breg17:
3561 case DW_OP_breg18:
3562 case DW_OP_breg19:
3563 case DW_OP_breg20:
3564 case DW_OP_breg21:
3565 case DW_OP_breg22:
3566 case DW_OP_breg23:
3567 case DW_OP_breg24:
3568 case DW_OP_breg25:
3569 case DW_OP_breg26:
3570 case DW_OP_breg27:
3571 case DW_OP_breg28:
3572 case DW_OP_breg29:
3573 case DW_OP_breg30:
3574 case DW_OP_breg31:
3575 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3576 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3577 break;
3578 case DW_OP_bregx:
3579 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3580 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3581 break;
3582 case DW_OP_deref:
3583 cfa->indirect = 1;
3584 break;
3585 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3586 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3587 break;
3588 default:
3589 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3590 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3594 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3596 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3597 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3599 /* .debug_str support. */
3600 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3602 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3603 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3604 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3605 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3606 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3607 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3608 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3609 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3610 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3611 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3612 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3613 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3614 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3615 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3616 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3617 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3619 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3621 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3623 dwarf2out_init,
3624 dwarf2out_finish,
3625 dwarf2out_define,
3626 dwarf2out_undef,
3627 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3628 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3629 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3630 dwarf2out_end_block,
3631 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3632 dwarf2out_source_line,
3633 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3634 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3635 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3636 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3637 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3638 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3639 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3640 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3641 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3642 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3643 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3644 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3645 something tries to reference them. */
3646 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3647 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3648 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3649 dwarf2out_var_location,
3650 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3651 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3653 #endif
3655 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3656 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3657 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3659 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3660 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3661 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3662 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3664 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3665 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3667 typedef long int dw_offset;
3669 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3671 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3672 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3673 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3674 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3675 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3677 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3678 line number associated with the label generated for that
3679 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3680 the line number entry. */
3682 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3684 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3685 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3687 dw_line_info_entry;
3689 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3690 own sequence. */
3691 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3693 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3694 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3695 unsigned long function;
3697 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3699 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3700 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3701 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3703 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3705 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3706 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3708 dw_attr_node;
3710 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3711 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3713 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
3714 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3715 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
3717 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3719 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3720 char *die_symbol;
3721 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3722 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3723 dw_die_ref die_child;
3724 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3725 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3726 dw_offset die_offset;
3727 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3728 int die_mark;
3729 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
3730 int die_perennial_p;
3731 unsigned int decl_id;
3733 die_node;
3735 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
3736 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
3737 c = die->die_child; \
3738 if (c) do { \
3739 c = c->die_sib; \
3740 expr; \
3741 } while (c != die->die_child); \
3742 } while (0)
3744 /* The pubname structure */
3746 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3748 dw_die_ref die;
3749 char *name;
3751 pubname_entry;
3753 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3755 int block_num;
3758 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3759 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3761 dw_die_ref die;
3762 tree created_for;
3763 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3765 limbo_die_node;
3767 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3768 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3769 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3770 #endif
3772 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3773 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3775 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3776 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3777 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3778 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3779 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3780 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3782 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3783 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3784 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3785 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3786 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3787 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3788 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3789 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3790 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3791 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3793 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3794 language, and compiler version. */
3796 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3797 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3798 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3800 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3801 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3803 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3804 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3805 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3806 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3807 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3809 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3810 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3811 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3812 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3813 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3814 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3816 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3817 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3818 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3819 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3820 #else
3821 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3822 #endif
3823 #endif
3825 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3826 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3827 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3829 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3830 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3832 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3833 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3835 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3836 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3837 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3838 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3839 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3841 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3842 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3843 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3844 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3845 #endif
3847 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3848 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3850 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3851 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3853 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3854 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table;
3855 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table_emitted;
3856 static GTY(()) size_t file_table_last_lookup_index;
3858 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3859 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3860 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3862 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3863 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3865 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3866 const char * GTY (()) label;
3867 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3868 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3871 /* Variable location list. */
3872 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3874 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3876 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3877 it is marked through the chain. */
3878 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3880 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3881 unsigned int decl_id;
3883 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3886 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3887 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3889 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3890 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3891 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3892 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3893 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3895 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3896 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3898 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3899 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3901 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3902 abbrev_die_table. */
3903 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3905 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3906 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3907 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3908 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3910 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3911 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3913 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3914 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3916 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
3917 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3919 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3920 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3921 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3922 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3924 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3925 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3927 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3928 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3930 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3931 line_info_table. */
3932 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3934 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3935 accessible names. */
3936 static GTY ((length ("pubname_table_allocated"))) pubname_ref pubname_table;
3938 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3939 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3941 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3942 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3944 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3945 pubname_table. */
3946 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3948 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3949 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3951 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3952 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3954 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3955 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3957 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3958 arange_table. */
3959 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3961 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3962 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3964 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3965 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3967 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3968 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3970 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3971 ranges_table. */
3972 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3974 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3975 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3977 /* Unique label counter. */
3978 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3980 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3981 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3982 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3983 #endif
3984 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3985 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3986 #endif
3988 /* Number of file tables emitted in maybe_emit_file(). */
3989 static GTY(()) int emitcount = 0;
3991 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3992 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3994 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3996 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3997 within the current function. */
3998 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4000 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
4002 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
4003 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4004 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
4005 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4006 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4007 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4008 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
4009 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
4010 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4011 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4012 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4013 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4014 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4015 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4016 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4017 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4018 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4019 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4020 unsigned long);
4021 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4022 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4023 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4024 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4025 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4026 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4027 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4028 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4029 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4030 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4031 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4032 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4033 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4034 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4035 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4036 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4037 dw_loc_list_ref);
4038 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4039 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4040 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4041 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4042 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4043 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4044 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4045 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4046 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4047 unsigned long);
4048 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4049 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4050 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4051 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4052 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4053 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4054 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4055 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4056 static bool is_c_family (void);
4057 static bool is_cxx (void);
4058 static bool is_java (void);
4059 static bool is_fortran (void);
4060 static bool is_ada (void);
4061 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4062 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4063 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4064 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4065 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4066 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4067 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4068 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4069 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4070 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4071 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4072 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4073 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4074 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4075 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4076 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4077 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4078 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4079 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4080 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4081 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4082 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4083 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4084 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4085 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4086 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4087 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4088 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4089 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4090 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4091 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4092 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4093 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4094 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4095 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4096 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4097 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4098 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4099 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4100 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4101 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4102 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4103 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4104 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4105 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4106 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4107 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4108 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (void);
4109 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4110 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4111 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4112 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4113 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4114 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4115 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4116 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4117 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4118 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4119 static void output_pubnames (void);
4120 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4121 static void output_aranges (void);
4122 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4123 static void output_ranges (void);
4124 static void output_line_info (void);
4125 static void output_file_names (void);
4126 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4127 static tree root_type (tree);
4128 static int is_base_type (tree);
4129 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4130 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4131 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4132 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4133 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4134 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4135 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4136 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4137 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4138 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4139 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4140 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4141 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4142 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4143 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4144 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4145 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4146 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4147 static tree field_type (tree);
4148 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4149 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4150 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4151 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4152 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4153 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4154 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4155 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4156 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4157 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4158 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4159 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4160 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4161 enum dwarf_attribute);
4162 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4163 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4164 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4165 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4166 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4167 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4168 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4169 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4170 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4171 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4172 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4173 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4174 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4175 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4176 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4177 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4178 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4179 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4180 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4181 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4182 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4183 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4184 #if 0
4185 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4186 #endif
4187 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4188 #if 0
4189 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4190 #endif
4191 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4192 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4193 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4194 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4195 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4196 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4197 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4198 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4199 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4200 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4201 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4202 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4203 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4204 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4205 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4206 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4207 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4208 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4209 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4210 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4211 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4212 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4213 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4214 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4215 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4216 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4217 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4218 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4219 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4220 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4221 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4222 static unsigned lookup_filename (const char *);
4223 static void init_file_table (void);
4224 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4225 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4226 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4227 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4228 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4229 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4230 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4231 const char *, const char *,
4232 const char *);
4233 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4234 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4236 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4237 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4238 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4239 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4240 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4241 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4242 static int maybe_emit_file (int);
4244 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4245 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4246 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4247 #endif
4248 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4249 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4250 #endif
4251 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4252 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4253 #endif
4254 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4255 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4256 #endif
4257 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4258 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4259 #endif
4260 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4261 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4262 #endif
4263 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4264 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4265 #endif
4266 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4267 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4268 #endif
4269 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4270 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4271 #endif
4273 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4274 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4275 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4276 #endif
4278 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4279 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4280 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
4281 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4282 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4284 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4285 the section names themselves. */
4287 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4288 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4289 #endif
4290 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4291 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4292 #endif
4293 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4294 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4295 #endif
4296 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4297 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4298 #endif
4299 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4300 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4301 #endif
4302 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4303 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4304 #endif
4305 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4306 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4307 #endif
4308 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4309 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4310 #endif
4312 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4313 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4314 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4315 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4316 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4318 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4319 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4320 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4321 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4322 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4323 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4324 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4325 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4326 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4327 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4329 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4330 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4331 #endif
4332 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4333 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4334 #endif
4335 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4336 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4337 #endif
4338 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4339 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4340 #endif
4341 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4342 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4343 #endif
4344 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4345 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4346 #endif
4348 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4349 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4351 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4353 void
4354 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4356 demangle_name_func = func;
4359 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4361 static inline int
4362 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4364 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4365 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4366 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4369 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4370 removed. */
4372 static inline tree
4373 type_main_variant (tree type)
4375 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4377 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4378 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4379 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4380 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4381 here. */
4382 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4383 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4384 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4386 return type;
4389 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4391 static inline int
4392 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4394 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4396 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4397 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4400 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4402 static const char *
4403 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4405 switch (tag)
4407 case DW_TAG_padding:
4408 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4409 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4410 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4411 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4412 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4413 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4414 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4415 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4416 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4417 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4418 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4419 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4420 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4421 case DW_TAG_label:
4422 return "DW_TAG_label";
4423 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4424 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4425 case DW_TAG_member:
4426 return "DW_TAG_member";
4427 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4428 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4429 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4430 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4431 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4432 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4433 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4434 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4435 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4436 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4437 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4438 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4439 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4440 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4441 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4442 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4443 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4444 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4445 case DW_TAG_variant:
4446 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4447 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4448 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4449 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4450 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4451 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4452 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4453 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4454 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4455 case DW_TAG_module:
4456 return "DW_TAG_module";
4457 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4458 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4459 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4460 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4461 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4462 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4463 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4464 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4465 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4466 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4467 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4468 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4469 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4470 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4471 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4472 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4473 case DW_TAG_constant:
4474 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4475 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4476 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4477 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4478 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4479 case DW_TAG_friend:
4480 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4481 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4482 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4483 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4484 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4485 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4486 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4487 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4488 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4489 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4490 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4491 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4492 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4493 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4494 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4495 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4496 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4497 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4498 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4499 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4500 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4501 case DW_TAG_variable:
4502 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4503 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4504 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4505 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4506 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4507 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4508 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4509 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4510 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4511 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4512 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4513 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4514 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4515 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4516 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4517 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4518 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4519 default:
4520 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4524 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4526 static const char *
4527 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4529 switch (attr)
4531 case DW_AT_sibling:
4532 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4533 case DW_AT_location:
4534 return "DW_AT_location";
4535 case DW_AT_name:
4536 return "DW_AT_name";
4537 case DW_AT_ordering:
4538 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4539 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4540 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4541 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4542 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4543 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4544 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4545 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4546 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4547 case DW_AT_element_list:
4548 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4549 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4550 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4551 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4552 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4553 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4554 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4555 case DW_AT_language:
4556 return "DW_AT_language";
4557 case DW_AT_member:
4558 return "DW_AT_member";
4559 case DW_AT_discr:
4560 return "DW_AT_discr";
4561 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4562 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4563 case DW_AT_visibility:
4564 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4565 case DW_AT_import:
4566 return "DW_AT_import";
4567 case DW_AT_string_length:
4568 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4569 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4570 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4571 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4572 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4573 case DW_AT_const_value:
4574 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4575 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4576 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4577 case DW_AT_default_value:
4578 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4579 case DW_AT_inline:
4580 return "DW_AT_inline";
4581 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4582 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4583 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4584 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4585 case DW_AT_producer:
4586 return "DW_AT_producer";
4587 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4588 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4589 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4590 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4591 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4592 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4593 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4594 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4595 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4596 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4597 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4598 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4599 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4600 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4601 case DW_AT_address_class:
4602 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4603 case DW_AT_artificial:
4604 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4605 case DW_AT_base_types:
4606 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4607 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4608 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4609 case DW_AT_count:
4610 return "DW_AT_count";
4611 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4612 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4613 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4614 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4615 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4616 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4617 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4618 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4619 case DW_AT_declaration:
4620 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4621 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4622 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4623 case DW_AT_encoding:
4624 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4625 case DW_AT_external:
4626 return "DW_AT_external";
4627 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4628 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4629 case DW_AT_friend:
4630 return "DW_AT_friend";
4631 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4632 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4633 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4634 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4635 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4636 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4637 case DW_AT_priority:
4638 return "DW_AT_priority";
4639 case DW_AT_segment:
4640 return "DW_AT_segment";
4641 case DW_AT_specification:
4642 return "DW_AT_specification";
4643 case DW_AT_static_link:
4644 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4645 case DW_AT_type:
4646 return "DW_AT_type";
4647 case DW_AT_use_location:
4648 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4649 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4650 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4651 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4652 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4653 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4654 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4656 case DW_AT_allocated:
4657 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4658 case DW_AT_associated:
4659 return "DW_AT_associated";
4660 case DW_AT_data_location:
4661 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4662 case DW_AT_stride:
4663 return "DW_AT_stride";
4664 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4665 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4666 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4667 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4668 case DW_AT_extension:
4669 return "DW_AT_extension";
4670 case DW_AT_ranges:
4671 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4672 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4673 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4674 case DW_AT_call_column:
4675 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4676 case DW_AT_call_file:
4677 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4678 case DW_AT_call_line:
4679 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4681 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4682 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4683 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4684 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4685 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4686 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4687 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4688 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4689 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4690 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4691 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4692 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4693 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4694 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4695 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4696 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4697 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4698 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4699 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4700 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4701 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4702 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4704 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4705 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4706 case DW_AT_src_info:
4707 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4708 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4709 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4710 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4711 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4712 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4713 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4714 case DW_AT_body_end:
4715 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4716 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4717 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4719 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4720 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4722 default:
4723 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4727 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4729 static const char *
4730 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4732 switch (form)
4734 case DW_FORM_addr:
4735 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4736 case DW_FORM_block2:
4737 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4738 case DW_FORM_block4:
4739 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4740 case DW_FORM_data2:
4741 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4742 case DW_FORM_data4:
4743 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4744 case DW_FORM_data8:
4745 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4746 case DW_FORM_string:
4747 return "DW_FORM_string";
4748 case DW_FORM_block:
4749 return "DW_FORM_block";
4750 case DW_FORM_block1:
4751 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4752 case DW_FORM_data1:
4753 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4754 case DW_FORM_flag:
4755 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4756 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4757 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4758 case DW_FORM_strp:
4759 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4760 case DW_FORM_udata:
4761 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4762 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4763 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4764 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4765 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4766 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4767 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4768 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4769 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4770 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4771 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4772 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4773 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4774 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4775 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4776 default:
4777 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4781 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4782 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4783 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4784 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4785 given block. */
4787 static tree
4788 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4790 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4791 return NULL_TREE;
4793 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4794 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4795 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4796 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4797 return NULL_TREE;
4799 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4800 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4801 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4803 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4806 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4807 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4808 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4809 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4810 given block. */
4812 static tree
4813 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4815 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4817 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4818 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4819 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4820 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4821 return NULL_TREE;
4823 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4824 return NULL_TREE;
4825 else
4827 tree ret_val;
4828 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4832 ret_val = lookahead;
4833 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4834 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4836 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4838 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4839 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4840 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4841 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4842 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4843 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
4844 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4845 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4847 return ret_val;
4851 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4852 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4853 parameter. */
4855 static tree
4856 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4858 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4860 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4861 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4862 else
4863 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4864 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4866 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4867 context = NULL_TREE;
4869 return context;
4872 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4874 static inline void
4875 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4877 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4878 if (die == NULL)
4879 return;
4881 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
4882 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
4883 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
4886 static inline enum dw_val_class
4887 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4889 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4892 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4894 static inline void
4895 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4897 dw_attr_node attr;
4899 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4900 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4901 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4902 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4905 static inline unsigned
4906 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4908 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4909 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4912 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4914 static inline void
4915 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4917 dw_attr_node attr;
4919 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4920 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4921 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4922 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4925 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4926 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4928 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4929 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4932 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4934 static inline void
4935 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4936 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4938 dw_attr_node attr;
4940 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4941 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4942 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4943 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4946 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4947 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4949 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4950 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4953 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4955 static inline void
4956 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4957 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4959 dw_attr_node attr;
4961 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4962 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4963 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4964 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4965 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4968 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4970 static inline void
4971 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4972 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4974 dw_attr_node attr;
4976 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4977 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4978 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4979 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4980 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4981 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4984 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4986 static hashval_t
4987 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
4989 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
4992 static int
4993 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
4995 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
4996 (const char *)x2) == 0;
4999 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
5001 static inline void
5002 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5004 dw_attr_node attr;
5005 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5006 void **slot;
5008 if (! debug_str_hash)
5009 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5010 debug_str_eq, NULL);
5012 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5013 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5014 if (*slot == NULL)
5015 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5016 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5017 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5018 node->refcount++;
5020 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5021 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5022 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5023 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5026 static inline const char *
5027 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5029 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5030 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5033 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5034 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
5036 static int
5037 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5039 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5040 unsigned int len;
5041 char label[32];
5043 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5045 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5046 if (node->form)
5047 return node->form;
5049 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5051 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5052 always better to put it inline. */
5053 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5054 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5056 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5057 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5058 single module. */
5059 if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5060 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5061 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5063 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5064 ++dw2_string_counter;
5065 node->label = xstrdup (label);
5067 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5070 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5072 static inline void
5073 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5075 dw_attr_node attr;
5077 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5078 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5079 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5080 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5081 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5084 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5085 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5087 static inline void
5088 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5090 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5091 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5092 targ_die->die_definition = die;
5095 static inline dw_die_ref
5096 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5098 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5099 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5102 static inline int
5103 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5105 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5106 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5108 return 0;
5111 static inline void
5112 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5114 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5115 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5118 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5120 static inline void
5121 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5123 dw_attr_node attr;
5125 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5126 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5127 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5128 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5131 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5133 static inline void
5134 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5136 dw_attr_node attr;
5138 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5139 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5140 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5141 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5144 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5145 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5147 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5148 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5151 static inline void
5152 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5154 dw_attr_node attr;
5156 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5157 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5158 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5159 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5160 have_location_lists = true;
5163 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5164 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5166 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5167 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5170 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5172 static inline void
5173 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5175 dw_attr_node attr;
5177 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5178 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5179 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5180 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5183 static inline rtx
5184 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5186 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5187 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5190 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5192 static inline void
5193 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5195 dw_attr_node attr;
5197 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5198 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5199 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5200 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5203 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5204 debug_line section. */
5206 static inline void
5207 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5208 const char *label)
5210 dw_attr_node attr;
5212 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5213 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5214 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5215 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5218 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5219 debug_macinfo section. */
5221 static inline void
5222 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5223 const char *label)
5225 dw_attr_node attr;
5227 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5228 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5229 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5230 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5233 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5235 static inline void
5236 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5237 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5239 dw_attr_node attr;
5241 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5242 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5243 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5244 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5247 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5249 static void
5250 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5251 long unsigned int offset)
5253 dw_attr_node attr;
5255 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5256 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5257 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5258 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5261 static inline const char *
5262 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5264 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5265 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5266 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5267 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5270 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5272 static dw_attr_ref
5273 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5275 dw_attr_ref a;
5276 unsigned ix;
5277 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5279 if (! die)
5280 return NULL;
5282 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5283 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5284 return a;
5285 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5286 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5287 spec = AT_ref (a);
5289 if (spec)
5290 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5292 return NULL;
5295 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5296 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5297 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5299 static inline const char *
5300 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5302 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5304 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5307 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5308 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5309 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5311 static inline const char *
5312 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5314 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5316 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5319 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5320 NULL if it is not present. */
5322 static inline const char *
5323 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5325 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5327 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5330 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5331 if it is not present. */
5333 static inline int
5334 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5336 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5338 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5341 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5342 if it is not present. */
5344 static inline unsigned
5345 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5347 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5349 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5352 static inline dw_die_ref
5353 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5355 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5357 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5360 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5362 static inline bool
5363 is_c_family (void)
5365 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5367 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5368 || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5369 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5372 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5374 static inline bool
5375 is_cxx (void)
5377 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5379 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5382 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5384 static inline bool
5385 is_fortran (void)
5387 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5389 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5390 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5391 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5394 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5396 static inline bool
5397 is_java (void)
5399 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5401 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5404 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5406 static inline bool
5407 is_ada (void)
5409 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5411 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5414 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5416 static void
5417 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5419 dw_attr_ref a;
5420 unsigned ix;
5422 if (! die)
5423 return;
5425 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5426 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5428 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5429 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5430 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5432 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5433 that are needed. */
5434 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5435 return;
5439 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5440 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5442 static void
5443 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5445 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5446 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5447 if (prev == child)
5449 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5450 prev = NULL;
5452 else
5453 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5454 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5455 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5458 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5459 matches TAG. */
5461 static void
5462 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5464 dw_die_ref c;
5466 c = die->die_child;
5467 if (c) do {
5468 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5469 c = c->die_sib;
5470 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5472 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5473 /* Might have removed every child. */
5474 if (c == c->die_sib)
5475 return;
5476 c = c->die_sib;
5478 } while (c != die->die_child);
5481 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5483 static void
5484 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5486 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5487 if (! die || ! child_die)
5488 return;
5489 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5491 child_die->die_parent = die;
5492 if (die->die_child)
5494 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5495 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5497 else
5498 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5499 die->die_child = child_die;
5502 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5503 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5504 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5506 static void
5507 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5509 dw_die_ref p;
5511 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5512 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5513 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5515 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5517 if (tmp)
5518 child = tmp;
5521 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5522 || (child->die_parent
5523 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5525 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5526 if (p->die_sib == child)
5528 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5529 break;
5532 add_child_die (parent, child);
5535 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5537 static inline dw_die_ref
5538 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5540 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5542 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5544 if (parent_die != NULL)
5545 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5546 else
5548 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5550 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5551 limbo_node->die = die;
5552 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5553 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5554 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5557 return die;
5560 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5562 static inline dw_die_ref
5563 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5565 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5568 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5570 static inline void
5571 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5573 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5576 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5578 static hashval_t
5579 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5581 return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5584 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5586 static int
5587 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5589 return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5592 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5594 static inline dw_die_ref
5595 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5597 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5600 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5602 static hashval_t
5603 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5605 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5608 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5609 UID of decl *Y. */
5611 static int
5612 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5614 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5617 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5619 static inline var_loc_list *
5620 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5622 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5625 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5627 static void
5628 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5630 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5631 void **slot;
5633 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5634 *slot = decl_die;
5635 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5638 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5640 static void
5641 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5643 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5644 var_loc_list *temp;
5645 void **slot;
5647 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5648 if (*slot == NULL)
5650 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5651 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5652 *slot = temp;
5654 else
5655 temp = *slot;
5657 if (temp->last)
5659 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5660 we have nothing to do. */
5661 if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5662 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5664 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5665 temp->last->next = loc;
5666 temp->last = loc;
5669 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5670 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5672 temp->first = loc;
5673 temp->last = loc;
5677 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5678 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5679 the DIE internal representation. */
5680 static int print_indent;
5682 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5684 static inline void
5685 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5687 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5690 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5691 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5693 static void
5694 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5696 dw_attr_ref a;
5697 dw_die_ref c;
5698 unsigned ix;
5700 print_spaces (outfile);
5701 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5702 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5703 print_spaces (outfile);
5704 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5705 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5707 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5709 print_spaces (outfile);
5710 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5712 switch (AT_class (a))
5714 case dw_val_class_addr:
5715 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5716 break;
5717 case dw_val_class_offset:
5718 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5719 break;
5720 case dw_val_class_loc:
5721 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5722 break;
5723 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5724 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5725 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5726 break;
5727 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5728 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5729 break;
5730 case dw_val_class_const:
5731 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5732 break;
5733 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5734 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5735 break;
5736 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5737 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5738 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5739 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5740 break;
5741 case dw_val_class_vec:
5742 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5743 break;
5744 case dw_val_class_flag:
5745 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5746 break;
5747 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5748 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5750 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5751 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5752 else
5753 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5755 else
5756 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5757 break;
5758 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5759 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5760 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5761 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5762 break;
5763 case dw_val_class_str:
5764 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5765 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5766 else
5767 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5768 break;
5769 default:
5770 break;
5773 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5776 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5778 print_indent += 4;
5779 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5780 print_indent -= 4;
5782 if (print_indent == 0)
5783 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5786 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5787 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5789 static void
5790 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5792 unsigned i;
5793 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5795 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5796 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5798 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5799 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5800 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s",
5801 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, line_info->dw_file_num));
5802 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5803 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5806 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5809 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5811 void
5812 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5814 print_die (die, stderr);
5817 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5818 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5820 void
5821 debug_dwarf (void)
5823 print_indent = 0;
5824 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5825 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5826 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5829 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5830 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5831 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5833 static dw_die_ref
5834 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5836 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5837 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5839 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5840 return new_unit;
5843 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5845 static dw_die_ref
5846 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5848 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5850 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5851 return new_unit;
5854 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5855 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5857 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5859 static inline void
5860 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5862 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5863 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5864 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5867 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5869 static void
5870 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5872 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5873 rtx r;
5875 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5877 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5878 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5879 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5880 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5881 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5882 return;
5884 switch (AT_class (at))
5886 case dw_val_class_const:
5887 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5888 break;
5889 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5890 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5891 break;
5892 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5893 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5894 break;
5895 case dw_val_class_vec:
5896 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5897 break;
5898 case dw_val_class_flag:
5899 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5900 break;
5901 case dw_val_class_str:
5902 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5903 break;
5905 case dw_val_class_addr:
5906 r = AT_addr (at);
5907 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5908 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5909 break;
5911 case dw_val_class_offset:
5912 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5913 break;
5915 case dw_val_class_loc:
5916 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5917 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5918 break;
5920 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5921 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5922 break;
5924 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5925 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5926 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5927 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5928 break;
5930 default:
5931 break;
5935 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5937 static void
5938 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5940 dw_die_ref c;
5941 dw_attr_ref a;
5942 unsigned ix;
5944 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5945 if (die->die_mark)
5947 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5948 return;
5950 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5952 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5954 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5955 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5957 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
5960 #undef CHECKSUM
5961 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5963 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
5964 static inline int
5965 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
5967 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
5968 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
5969 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
5972 /* Do the values look the same? */
5973 static int
5974 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
5976 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
5977 rtx r1, r2;
5979 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
5980 return 0;
5982 switch (v1->val_class)
5984 case dw_val_class_const:
5985 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
5986 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5987 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
5988 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5989 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
5990 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
5991 case dw_val_class_vec:
5992 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
5993 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
5994 return 0;
5995 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
5996 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
5997 return 0;
5998 return 1;
5999 case dw_val_class_flag:
6000 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6001 case dw_val_class_str:
6002 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6004 case dw_val_class_addr:
6005 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6006 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6007 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6008 return 0;
6009 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6010 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6012 case dw_val_class_offset:
6013 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6015 case dw_val_class_loc:
6016 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6017 loc1 && loc2;
6018 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6019 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6020 return 0;
6021 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6023 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6024 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6026 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6027 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6028 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6029 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6030 return 1;
6032 default:
6033 return 1;
6037 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6039 static int
6040 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6042 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6043 return 0;
6045 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
6046 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
6047 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
6048 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6049 || at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6050 return 1;
6052 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6055 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6057 static int
6058 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6060 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6061 dw_attr_ref a1;
6062 unsigned ix;
6064 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6065 if (die1->die_mark)
6066 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6067 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6069 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6070 return 0;
6072 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6073 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6074 return 0;
6076 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6077 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6078 return 0;
6080 c1 = die1->die_child;
6081 c2 = die2->die_child;
6082 if (! c1)
6084 if (c2)
6085 return 0;
6087 else
6088 for (;;)
6090 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6091 return 0;
6092 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6093 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6094 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6096 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6097 break;
6098 else
6099 return 0;
6103 return 1;
6106 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6108 static int
6109 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6111 int mark = 0;
6112 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6114 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6115 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6117 return ret;
6120 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6121 info section. */
6122 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6124 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6125 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6127 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6128 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6130 static void
6131 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6133 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6134 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6135 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6136 char *p;
6137 int i, mark;
6138 unsigned char checksum[16];
6139 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6141 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6142 the name filename of the unit. */
6144 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6145 mark = 0;
6146 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6147 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6148 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6150 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6151 clean_symbol_name (name);
6153 p = name + strlen (name);
6154 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6156 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6157 p += 2;
6160 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6161 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6164 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6166 static int
6167 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6169 switch (die->die_tag)
6171 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6172 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6173 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6174 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6175 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6176 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6177 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6178 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6179 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6180 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6181 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6182 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6183 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6184 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6185 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6186 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6187 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6188 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6189 return 1;
6190 default:
6191 return 0;
6195 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6196 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6197 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6198 compilations (functions). */
6200 static int
6201 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6203 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6204 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6205 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6206 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6208 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6209 return 0;
6211 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6212 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6213 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6214 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6216 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6218 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6221 return is_type_die (c);
6224 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6225 compilation unit. */
6227 static int
6228 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6230 return (is_type_die (c)
6231 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6232 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6233 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6236 static char *
6237 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6239 char buf[256];
6241 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6242 return xstrdup (buf);
6245 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6247 static void
6248 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6250 dw_die_ref c;
6252 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6254 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6256 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6258 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6259 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6260 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6262 else
6263 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6266 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6269 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6271 dw_die_ref cu;
6272 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6273 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6276 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6277 static hashval_t
6278 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6280 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6282 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6285 static int
6286 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6288 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6289 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6291 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6294 static void
6295 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6297 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6299 while (entry)
6301 next = entry->next;
6302 free (entry);
6303 entry = next;
6307 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6308 accordingly. */
6309 static int
6310 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6312 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6313 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6315 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6317 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6318 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6319 INSERT);
6320 entry = *slot;
6322 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6324 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6325 break;
6328 if (entry)
6330 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6331 return 1;
6334 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6335 entry->cu = cu;
6336 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6337 entry->next = *slot;
6338 *slot = entry;
6340 return 0;
6343 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6344 static void
6345 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6347 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6349 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6350 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6351 NO_INSERT);
6352 entry = *slot;
6354 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6357 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6358 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6359 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6361 static void
6362 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6364 dw_die_ref c;
6365 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6366 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6367 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6369 c = die->die_child;
6370 if (c) do {
6371 dw_die_ref prev = c;
6372 c = c->die_sib;
6373 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6374 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6376 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6378 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6379 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6381 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6382 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6383 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6384 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6385 else
6386 add_child_die (unit, c);
6387 c = next;
6388 if (c == die->die_child)
6389 break;
6391 } while (c != die->die_child);
6393 #if 0
6394 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6395 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6396 gcc_assert (!unit);
6397 #endif
6399 assign_symbol_names (die);
6400 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6401 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6402 node;
6403 node = node->next)
6405 int is_dupl;
6407 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6408 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6409 &comdat_symbol_number);
6410 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6411 if (is_dupl)
6412 *pnode = node->next;
6413 else
6415 pnode = &node->next;
6416 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6417 comdat_symbol_number);
6420 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6423 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6424 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6425 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6427 static void
6428 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6430 dw_die_ref c;
6432 if (! die->die_child)
6433 return;
6435 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6436 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6438 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6441 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6443 static void
6444 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6446 dw_die_ref c;
6447 dw_attr_ref a;
6448 unsigned ix;
6450 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6451 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6452 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6454 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6457 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6458 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6459 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6460 die are visited recursively. */
6462 static void
6463 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6465 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6466 unsigned int n_alloc;
6467 dw_die_ref c;
6468 dw_attr_ref a;
6469 unsigned ix;
6471 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6472 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6473 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6474 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6475 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6477 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6479 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6482 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6484 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6485 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6486 unsigned ix;
6487 bool ok = true;
6489 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6490 continue;
6491 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6492 continue;
6494 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6495 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6496 continue;
6498 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6500 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6501 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6502 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6504 ok = false;
6505 break;
6508 if (ok)
6509 break;
6512 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6514 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6516 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6517 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6518 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6520 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6521 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6522 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6525 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6526 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6529 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6530 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6533 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6535 static int
6536 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6538 int log;
6540 if (value == 0)
6541 log = 0;
6542 else
6543 log = floor_log2 (value);
6545 log = log / 8;
6546 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6548 return log;
6551 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6552 .debug_info section. */
6554 static unsigned long
6555 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6557 unsigned long size = 0;
6558 dw_attr_ref a;
6559 unsigned ix;
6561 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6562 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6564 switch (AT_class (a))
6566 case dw_val_class_addr:
6567 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6568 break;
6569 case dw_val_class_offset:
6570 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6571 break;
6572 case dw_val_class_loc:
6574 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6576 /* Block length. */
6577 size += constant_size (lsize);
6578 size += lsize;
6580 break;
6581 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6582 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6583 break;
6584 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6585 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6586 break;
6587 case dw_val_class_const:
6588 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6589 break;
6590 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6591 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6592 break;
6593 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6594 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6595 break;
6596 case dw_val_class_vec:
6597 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6598 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6599 break;
6600 case dw_val_class_flag:
6601 size += 1;
6602 break;
6603 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6604 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6605 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6606 else
6607 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6608 break;
6609 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6610 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6611 break;
6612 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6613 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6614 break;
6615 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6616 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6617 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6618 break;
6619 case dw_val_class_str:
6620 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6621 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6622 else
6623 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6624 break;
6625 default:
6626 gcc_unreachable ();
6630 return size;
6633 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6634 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6635 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6636 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6638 static void
6639 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6641 dw_die_ref c;
6643 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6644 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6646 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6648 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6649 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6650 next_die_offset += 1;
6653 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6654 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6655 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6656 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6658 static void
6659 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6661 dw_die_ref c;
6663 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6665 die->die_mark = 1;
6666 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6669 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6671 static void
6672 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6674 dw_die_ref c;
6676 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6678 die->die_mark = 0;
6679 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6682 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6684 static void
6685 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6687 dw_die_ref c;
6688 dw_attr_ref a;
6689 unsigned ix;
6691 if (!die->die_mark)
6692 return;
6693 die->die_mark = 0;
6695 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6697 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6698 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6699 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6702 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
6703 compilation unit. */
6705 static unsigned long
6706 size_of_pubnames (void)
6708 unsigned long size;
6709 unsigned i;
6711 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6712 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6714 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6715 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6718 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6719 return size;
6722 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6724 static unsigned long
6725 size_of_aranges (void)
6727 unsigned long size;
6729 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6731 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6732 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6733 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6735 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6736 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6737 return size;
6740 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6742 static enum dwarf_form
6743 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6745 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6747 case dw_val_class_addr:
6748 return DW_FORM_addr;
6749 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6750 case dw_val_class_offset:
6751 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6752 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6754 case 4:
6755 return DW_FORM_data4;
6756 case 8:
6757 return DW_FORM_data8;
6758 default:
6759 gcc_unreachable ();
6761 case dw_val_class_loc:
6762 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6764 case 1:
6765 return DW_FORM_block1;
6766 case 2:
6767 return DW_FORM_block2;
6768 default:
6769 gcc_unreachable ();
6771 case dw_val_class_const:
6772 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6773 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6774 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6776 case 1:
6777 return DW_FORM_data1;
6778 case 2:
6779 return DW_FORM_data2;
6780 case 4:
6781 return DW_FORM_data4;
6782 case 8:
6783 return DW_FORM_data8;
6784 default:
6785 gcc_unreachable ();
6787 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6788 return DW_FORM_block1;
6789 case dw_val_class_vec:
6790 return DW_FORM_block1;
6791 case dw_val_class_flag:
6792 return DW_FORM_flag;
6793 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6794 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6795 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6796 else
6797 return DW_FORM_ref;
6798 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6799 return DW_FORM_data;
6800 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6801 return DW_FORM_addr;
6802 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6803 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6804 return DW_FORM_data;
6805 case dw_val_class_str:
6806 return AT_string_form (a);
6808 default:
6809 gcc_unreachable ();
6813 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6815 static void
6816 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6818 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6820 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6823 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6824 table. */
6826 static void
6827 output_abbrev_section (void)
6829 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6831 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6833 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6834 unsigned ix;
6835 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6837 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6838 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6839 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6841 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6842 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6843 else
6844 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6846 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
6847 ix++)
6849 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6850 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6851 output_value_format (a_attr);
6854 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6855 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6858 /* Terminate the table. */
6859 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6862 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6864 static inline void
6865 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6867 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6869 if (sym == 0)
6870 return;
6872 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6873 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6874 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6875 will break. */
6876 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6878 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6881 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6882 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6883 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6885 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6886 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6887 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6889 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6891 retlist->begin = begin;
6892 retlist->end = end;
6893 retlist->expr = expr;
6894 retlist->section = section;
6895 if (gensym)
6896 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6898 return retlist;
6901 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6903 static inline void
6904 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6905 const char *begin, const char *end,
6906 const char *section)
6908 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6910 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6911 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6914 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6915 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6918 static void
6919 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6921 dw_fde_ref fde;
6923 gcc_assert (cfun);
6925 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6926 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6927 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6928 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6929 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6930 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6931 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
6933 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
6934 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
6935 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
6938 /* Output the location list given to us. */
6940 static void
6941 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
6943 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6945 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6947 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
6948 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
6950 unsigned long size;
6951 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
6953 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6954 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6955 list_head->ll_symbol);
6956 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6957 "Location list end address (%s)",
6958 list_head->ll_symbol);
6960 else
6962 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
6963 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6964 list_head->ll_symbol);
6965 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
6966 "Location list end address (%s)",
6967 list_head->ll_symbol);
6969 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6971 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6972 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
6973 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6975 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
6978 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
6979 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
6980 list_head->ll_symbol);
6981 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
6982 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
6983 list_head->ll_symbol);
6986 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
6987 the definitions of each child DIE. */
6989 static void
6990 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
6992 dw_attr_ref a;
6993 dw_die_ref c;
6994 unsigned long size;
6995 unsigned ix;
6997 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
6998 them to point to. */
6999 if (die->die_symbol)
7000 output_die_symbol (die);
7002 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7003 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7005 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7007 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7009 switch (AT_class (a))
7011 case dw_val_class_addr:
7012 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7013 break;
7015 case dw_val_class_offset:
7016 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7017 "%s", name);
7018 break;
7020 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7022 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7024 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7025 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7026 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7027 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7028 *p = '\0';
7030 break;
7032 case dw_val_class_loc:
7033 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7035 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7036 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7038 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7039 break;
7041 case dw_val_class_const:
7042 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7043 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7044 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7045 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7046 break;
7048 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7049 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7050 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7051 break;
7053 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7055 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7057 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7058 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7059 "%s", name);
7061 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7063 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7064 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7066 else
7068 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7069 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7072 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7073 first, "long long constant");
7074 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7075 second, NULL);
7077 break;
7079 case dw_val_class_vec:
7081 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7082 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7083 unsigned int i;
7084 unsigned char *p;
7086 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7087 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7089 elt_size /= 2;
7090 len *= 2;
7092 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7093 i < len;
7094 i++, p += elt_size)
7095 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7096 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7097 break;
7100 case dw_val_class_flag:
7101 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7102 break;
7104 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7106 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7108 gcc_assert (sym);
7109 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7110 "%s", name);
7112 break;
7114 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7115 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7117 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7119 gcc_assert (sym);
7120 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7121 "%s", name);
7123 else
7125 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7126 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7127 "%s", name);
7129 break;
7131 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7133 char l1[20];
7135 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7136 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7137 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7138 "%s", name);
7140 break;
7142 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7143 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7144 break;
7146 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7147 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7148 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7149 break;
7151 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7152 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7153 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7154 break;
7156 case dw_val_class_str:
7157 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7158 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7159 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7160 debug_str_section,
7161 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7162 else
7163 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7164 break;
7166 default:
7167 gcc_unreachable ();
7171 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7173 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7174 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7175 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7176 die->die_offset);
7179 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7180 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7182 static void
7183 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7185 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7186 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7187 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7188 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7189 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7190 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7191 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7192 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7193 debug_abbrev_section,
7194 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7195 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7198 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7200 static void
7201 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7203 const char *secname;
7204 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7206 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7207 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7208 return;
7210 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7211 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7212 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7213 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7214 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7215 mark_dies (die);
7217 build_abbrev_table (die);
7219 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7220 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7221 calc_die_sizes (die);
7223 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7224 if (oldsym)
7226 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7228 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7229 secname = tmp;
7230 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7231 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7233 else
7234 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7236 /* Output debugging information. */
7237 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7238 output_die (die);
7240 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7241 output_pubnames. */
7242 if (oldsym)
7244 unmark_dies (die);
7245 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7249 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
7251 static const char *
7252 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7254 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7257 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7259 static void
7260 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7262 pubname_ref p;
7264 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7265 return;
7267 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
7269 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7270 pubname_table
7271 = ggc_realloc (pubname_table,
7272 (pubname_table_allocated * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
7273 memset (pubname_table + pubname_table_in_use, 0,
7274 PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (pubname_entry));
7277 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
7278 p->die = die;
7279 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7282 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7283 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
7284 visible procedures. */
7286 static void
7287 output_pubnames (void)
7289 unsigned i;
7290 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
7292 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7293 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7294 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7295 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7296 "Length of Public Names Info");
7297 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7298 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7299 debug_info_section,
7300 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7301 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7302 "Compilation Unit Length");
7304 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
7306 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
7308 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7309 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7311 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7312 "DIE offset");
7314 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7317 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7320 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7322 static void
7323 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7325 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7326 return;
7328 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7330 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7331 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7332 (arange_table_allocated
7333 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7334 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7335 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7338 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7341 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7342 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7343 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7345 static void
7346 output_aranges (void)
7348 unsigned i;
7349 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7351 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7352 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7353 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7354 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7355 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7356 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7357 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7358 debug_info_section,
7359 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7360 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7361 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7363 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7364 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7366 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7367 pointer size. */
7368 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7369 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7370 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7371 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7374 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7375 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7376 text_section_label, "Length");
7377 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7379 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7380 "Address");
7381 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7382 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7385 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7387 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7389 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7390 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7392 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7394 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7395 "Address");
7396 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7397 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7399 else
7401 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7402 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7403 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7404 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7405 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7407 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7409 loc = AT_loc (a);
7410 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7412 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7413 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7414 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7415 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7416 "Length");
7420 /* Output the terminator words. */
7421 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7422 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7425 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7426 was placed. */
7428 static unsigned int
7429 add_ranges (tree block)
7431 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7433 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7435 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7436 ranges_table
7437 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7438 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7439 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7440 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7443 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7444 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7446 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7449 static void
7450 output_ranges (void)
7452 unsigned i;
7453 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7454 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7456 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7458 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7460 if (block_num)
7462 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7463 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7465 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7466 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7468 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7469 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7470 base of the text section. */
7471 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7473 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7474 text_section_label,
7475 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7476 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7477 text_section_label, NULL);
7480 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7481 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7482 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7483 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
7484 else
7486 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7487 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7488 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7491 fmt = NULL;
7493 else
7495 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7496 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7497 fmt = start_fmt;
7502 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7503 struct file_info
7505 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7506 char *fname; /* File name part. */
7507 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7508 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7509 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7512 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7513 files. */
7514 struct dir_info
7516 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7517 int length; /* Path length. */
7518 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7519 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7520 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7521 int used; /* Used in the end? */
7524 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7525 the directories in the path. */
7527 static int
7528 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7530 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7531 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7532 unsigned char *cp1;
7533 unsigned char *cp2;
7535 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7536 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7537 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7538 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7539 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7540 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7541 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7543 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7544 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7546 while (1)
7548 ++cp1;
7549 ++cp2;
7550 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7551 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7552 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7553 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7554 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7556 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7557 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7558 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7562 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7563 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7564 slowdowns with many input files. */
7566 static void
7567 output_file_names (void)
7569 struct file_info *files;
7570 struct dir_info *dirs;
7571 int *saved;
7572 int *savehere;
7573 int *backmap;
7574 size_t ndirs;
7575 int idx_offset;
7576 size_t i;
7577 int idx;
7579 /* Handle the case where file_table is empty. */
7580 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) <= 1)
7582 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7583 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7584 return;
7587 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7588 files = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct file_info));
7589 dirs = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7591 /* Sort the file names. */
7592 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7594 char *f;
7596 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7597 f = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i);
7598 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7599 f += 2;
7601 /* Create a new array entry. */
7602 files[i].path = f;
7603 files[i].length = strlen (f);
7604 files[i].file_idx = i;
7606 /* Search for the file name part. */
7607 f = strrchr (f, '/');
7608 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
7611 qsort (files + 1, VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) - 1,
7612 sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7614 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7615 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
7616 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
7617 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7618 dirs[0].count = 1;
7619 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7620 dirs[0].used = 0;
7621 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
7622 ndirs = 1;
7624 for (i = 2; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7625 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7626 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7627 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7629 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7630 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7631 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7633 else
7635 size_t j;
7637 /* This is a new directory. */
7638 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7639 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7640 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7641 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7642 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
7643 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7645 /* Search for a prefix. */
7646 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7647 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7648 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7649 && dirs[j].length > 1
7650 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7651 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7652 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7653 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7655 ++ndirs;
7658 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7659 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7660 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7661 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7662 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7663 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7664 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7665 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7667 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7668 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7670 size_t j;
7671 int total;
7673 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7674 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7675 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7676 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7678 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7680 savehere[j] = 0;
7681 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7683 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7684 dirs[j] path. */
7685 int k;
7687 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7688 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7689 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7691 if (k == (int) i)
7693 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
7694 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7695 dirs[i]. */
7696 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7697 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7702 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7703 directory. */
7704 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7706 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7707 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7708 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7710 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7711 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7713 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7714 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7719 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
7720 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
7721 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7722 backmap = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (int));
7723 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7725 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
7727 /* Mark this directory as used. */
7728 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
7731 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
7732 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
7733 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
7734 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
7735 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
7736 idx = 1;
7737 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7738 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7739 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
7741 dirs[i].used = idx++;
7742 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7743 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
7746 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7748 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
7749 exists. */
7750 if (idx_offset == 0)
7751 dirs[0].used = 0;
7753 /* Now write all the file names. */
7754 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7756 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7757 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7759 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7760 "File Entry: 0x%lx", (unsigned long) i);
7762 /* Include directory index. */
7763 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
7765 /* Modification time. */
7766 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7768 /* File length in bytes. */
7769 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7772 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7776 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7777 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7779 static void
7780 output_line_info (void)
7782 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7783 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7784 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7785 unsigned opc;
7786 unsigned n_op_args;
7787 unsigned long lt_index;
7788 unsigned long current_line;
7789 long line_offset;
7790 long line_delta;
7791 unsigned long current_file;
7792 unsigned long function;
7794 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7795 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7796 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7797 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7799 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7800 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7801 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7802 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7803 "Length of Source Line Info");
7804 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7806 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7807 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7808 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7810 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7811 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7812 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7813 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7814 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7815 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7816 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7817 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7818 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7819 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7821 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7822 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7823 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7824 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7825 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7826 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7827 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7828 "Special Opcode Base");
7830 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7832 switch (opc)
7834 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7835 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7836 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7837 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7838 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7839 n_op_args = 1;
7840 break;
7841 default:
7842 n_op_args = 0;
7843 break;
7846 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7847 opc, n_op_args);
7850 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7851 output_file_names ();
7852 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7854 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7855 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7856 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7858 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7859 a series of state machine operations. */
7860 current_file = 1;
7861 current_line = 1;
7863 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7864 strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7865 else
7866 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7867 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7869 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7871 #if 0
7872 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7873 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7874 prologue. */
7876 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7877 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7878 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7879 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7880 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7881 continue;
7882 #endif
7884 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7886 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7887 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7888 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7889 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7890 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7891 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7893 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7894 if (0)
7896 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7897 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7898 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7899 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7901 else
7903 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7904 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7905 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7906 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7907 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7908 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7911 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7913 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7914 different from the previous line. */
7915 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7917 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7918 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7919 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7920 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7921 current_file));
7924 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7925 that uses the least amount of space. */
7926 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7928 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7929 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7930 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7931 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7932 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7933 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7934 takes 1 byte. */
7935 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7936 "line %lu", current_line);
7937 else
7939 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7940 depending on the value being encoded. */
7941 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7942 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7943 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7944 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7947 else
7948 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7949 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7952 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7953 if (0)
7955 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7956 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7957 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7959 else
7961 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7962 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7963 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7964 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7968 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7969 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7971 function = 0;
7972 current_file = 1;
7973 current_line = 1;
7974 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
7976 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
7977 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
7979 #if 0
7980 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
7981 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7982 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
7983 && line_info->function == function)
7984 goto cont;
7985 #endif
7987 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
7988 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
7989 to handle it differently. */
7990 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
7991 lt_index);
7992 if (function != line_info->function)
7994 function = line_info->function;
7996 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
7997 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7998 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7999 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8000 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8002 else
8004 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
8005 if (0)
8007 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8008 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8009 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8011 else
8013 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8014 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8015 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8016 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8020 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8022 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8023 different from the previous line. */
8024 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8026 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8027 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8028 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
8029 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
8030 current_file));
8033 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8034 that uses the least amount of space. */
8035 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8037 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8038 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8039 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8040 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8041 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8042 "line %lu", current_line);
8043 else
8045 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8046 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8047 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8048 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8051 else
8052 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8054 #if 0
8055 cont:
8056 #endif
8058 lt_index++;
8060 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8061 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8062 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8064 current_file = 1;
8065 current_line = 1;
8067 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8068 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8069 if (0)
8071 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8072 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8073 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8075 else
8077 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8078 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8079 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8080 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8083 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8084 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8085 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8086 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8090 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8091 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8094 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8095 a DIE that describes the given type.
8097 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8098 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8100 static dw_die_ref
8101 base_type_die (tree type)
8103 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8104 enum dwarf_type encoding;
8106 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8107 return 0;
8109 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8111 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8112 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8114 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8115 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8116 else
8117 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8119 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8120 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8121 else
8122 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8123 break;
8125 case REAL_TYPE:
8126 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8127 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8128 else
8129 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8130 break;
8132 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8133 a user defined type for it. */
8134 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8135 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8136 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8137 else
8138 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8139 break;
8141 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8142 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8143 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8144 break;
8146 default:
8147 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8148 gcc_unreachable ();
8151 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8153 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8154 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8155 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8157 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8158 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8159 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8161 return base_type_result;
8164 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8165 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
8166 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8167 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8168 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8169 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8170 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8171 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
8173 static tree
8174 root_type (tree type)
8176 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8177 return error_mark_node;
8179 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8181 case ERROR_MARK:
8182 return error_mark_node;
8184 case POINTER_TYPE:
8185 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8186 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8188 default:
8189 return type_main_variant (type);
8193 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8194 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8196 static inline int
8197 is_base_type (tree type)
8199 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8201 case ERROR_MARK:
8202 case VOID_TYPE:
8203 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8204 case REAL_TYPE:
8205 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8206 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8207 return 1;
8209 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8210 case RECORD_TYPE:
8211 case UNION_TYPE:
8212 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8213 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8214 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8215 case METHOD_TYPE:
8216 case POINTER_TYPE:
8217 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8218 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8219 case LANG_TYPE:
8220 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8221 return 0;
8223 default:
8224 gcc_unreachable ();
8227 return 0;
8230 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8231 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8232 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8233 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8234 ERROR_MARK node. */
8236 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8237 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8239 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8240 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8241 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8242 return 0;
8243 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8244 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8245 else
8246 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8249 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8250 emitted as a subrange type. */
8252 static inline bool
8253 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8255 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8257 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8258 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8259 or an enumeral type. */
8261 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8262 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8263 return false;
8265 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8266 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8267 return false;
8269 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8270 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8271 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8272 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8273 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8274 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8275 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8276 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8278 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8279 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8280 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8281 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8282 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8283 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8284 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8285 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8286 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8287 keep checking the actual size. */
8288 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8289 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8291 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8292 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8294 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8295 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8297 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8298 return false;
8301 return true;
8304 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8305 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8307 static dw_die_ref
8308 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8310 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8311 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8313 if (context_die == NULL)
8314 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8316 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8318 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8320 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8321 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8322 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8325 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8326 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8327 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8328 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8329 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8330 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8332 return subrange_die;
8335 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8336 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8338 static dw_die_ref
8339 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8340 dw_die_ref context_die)
8342 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8343 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8344 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8345 tree item_type = NULL;
8346 tree qualified_type;
8347 tree name;
8349 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8350 return NULL;
8352 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8353 this type. */
8354 qualified_type
8355 = get_qualified_type (type,
8356 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8357 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8359 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8360 if (qualified_type)
8362 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8363 if (mod_type_die)
8364 return mod_type_die;
8367 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8369 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8370 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8372 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8374 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8376 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8377 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8378 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8380 else if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
8381 && (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8382 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)))
8383 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8384 type to which it refers. */
8385 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8386 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8387 context_die);
8388 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8391 if (is_const_type)
8393 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8394 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8396 else if (is_volatile_type)
8398 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8399 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8401 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8403 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8404 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8405 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8406 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8408 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8410 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8411 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8412 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8413 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8415 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8417 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8418 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8420 else if (is_base_type (type))
8421 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8422 else
8424 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8426 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8427 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8428 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8429 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8430 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8431 ..._TYPE node. */
8432 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8433 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8434 else
8435 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8436 not the main variant. */
8437 return lookup_type_die (type);
8440 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8441 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8442 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8443 if (name
8444 && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8446 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8447 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8448 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8449 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8450 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8451 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8454 if (qualified_type)
8455 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8457 if (item_type)
8458 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8459 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8460 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8461 types are possible in Ada. */
8462 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8463 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8464 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8465 context_die);
8467 if (sub_die != NULL)
8468 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8470 return mod_type_die;
8473 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8474 an enumerated type. */
8476 static inline int
8477 type_is_enum (tree type)
8479 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8482 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8484 static unsigned int
8485 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8487 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8489 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8491 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8493 int leaf_reg;
8495 leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8496 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8497 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8499 #endif
8501 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8504 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8505 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8506 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8508 static void
8509 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8511 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8513 if (*list_head != NULL)
8515 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8516 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8519 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8520 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8524 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8525 zero if there is none. */
8527 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8528 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8530 rtx regs;
8532 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8533 return 0;
8535 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8537 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8538 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8539 else
8540 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8543 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8544 a given hard register number. */
8546 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8547 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8549 if (regno <= 31)
8550 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8551 else
8552 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8555 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8556 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8558 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8559 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8561 int nregs, size, i;
8562 unsigned reg;
8563 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8565 reg = REGNO (rtl);
8566 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8568 int leaf_reg;
8570 leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8571 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8572 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8574 #endif
8575 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8576 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8578 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8579 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8581 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8583 loc_result = NULL;
8584 while (nregs--)
8586 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8588 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8589 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8590 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8591 ++reg;
8593 return loc_result;
8596 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8598 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8600 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8601 loc_result = NULL;
8603 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8605 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8607 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8608 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8609 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8610 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8612 return loc_result;
8615 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8617 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8618 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8620 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8622 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8623 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8624 if (i >= 0)
8626 if (i <= 31)
8627 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8628 else if (i <= 0xff)
8629 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8630 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8631 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8632 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8633 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8634 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8635 else
8636 op = DW_OP_constu;
8638 else
8640 if (i >= -0x80)
8641 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8642 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8643 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8644 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8645 || i >= -0x80000000)
8646 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8647 else
8648 op = DW_OP_consts;
8651 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8654 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8656 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8657 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8659 unsigned int regno;
8661 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8662 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
8663 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8664 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
8665 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8667 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8669 if (elim != reg)
8671 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8673 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8674 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8676 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8677 : stack_pointer_rtx));
8678 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8680 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8684 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8685 if (regno <= 31)
8686 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8687 else
8688 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8691 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8693 static inline int
8694 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8696 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8697 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8698 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8699 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8702 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8703 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8704 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8705 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8707 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8708 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8709 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8710 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8712 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8713 autoincrement addressing modes.
8715 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8716 location list for RTL.
8718 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8720 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8721 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8723 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8724 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8726 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8727 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8728 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8729 zeroth element of the array. */
8731 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8733 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8735 case POST_INC:
8736 case POST_DEC:
8737 case POST_MODIFY:
8738 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8739 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8741 /* ... fall through ... */
8743 case SUBREG:
8744 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8745 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8746 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8747 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8748 contains the given subreg. */
8749 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8751 /* ... fall through ... */
8753 case REG:
8754 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8755 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8756 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8757 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8758 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8759 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8760 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8761 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8762 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8763 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8764 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8765 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8766 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8767 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8768 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8769 break;
8771 case MEM:
8772 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8773 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8774 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8775 break;
8777 case LO_SUM:
8778 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8780 /* ... fall through ... */
8782 case LABEL_REF:
8783 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8784 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8785 pool. */
8786 case CONST:
8787 case SYMBOL_REF:
8788 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8789 by a different symbol. */
8790 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8792 bool marked;
8793 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8795 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8797 rtl = tmp;
8798 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8799 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8800 else
8801 marked = true;
8804 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8805 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8806 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8807 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8808 if (!marked)
8809 return 0;
8812 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8813 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8814 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8815 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8816 break;
8818 case PRE_MODIFY:
8819 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8820 PLUS code below. */
8821 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8822 goto plus;
8824 case PRE_INC:
8825 case PRE_DEC:
8826 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8827 below. */
8828 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8829 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8830 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8831 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8833 /* ... fall through ... */
8835 case PLUS:
8836 plus:
8837 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8838 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8839 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8840 else
8842 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8843 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8844 break;
8846 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8847 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8848 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8849 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8850 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8851 else
8853 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8854 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8855 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8856 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8859 break;
8861 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8862 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
8863 case MULT:
8864 op = DW_OP_mul;
8865 goto do_binop;
8867 case ASHIFT:
8868 op = DW_OP_shl;
8869 goto do_binop;
8871 case ASHIFTRT:
8872 op = DW_OP_shra;
8873 goto do_binop;
8875 case LSHIFTRT:
8876 op = DW_OP_shr;
8877 goto do_binop;
8879 do_binop:
8881 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8882 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
8884 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8885 break;
8887 mem_loc_result = op0;
8888 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
8889 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8890 break;
8893 case CONST_INT:
8894 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
8895 break;
8897 default:
8898 gcc_unreachable ();
8901 return mem_loc_result;
8904 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
8905 This is typically a complex variable. */
8907 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8908 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
8910 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
8911 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
8912 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
8914 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
8915 return 0;
8917 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
8918 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
8920 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
8921 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
8923 return cc_loc_result;
8926 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
8927 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
8928 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
8929 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
8930 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
8932 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
8934 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8935 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8937 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8939 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8941 case SUBREG:
8942 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8943 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8944 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8945 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8946 contains the given subreg. */
8947 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8949 /* ... fall through ... */
8951 case REG:
8952 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
8953 break;
8955 case MEM:
8956 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8957 break;
8959 case CONCAT:
8960 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
8961 break;
8963 case VAR_LOCATION:
8964 /* Single part. */
8965 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
8967 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
8968 break;
8971 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8972 /* FALLTHRU */
8974 case PARALLEL:
8976 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
8977 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
8978 enum machine_mode mode;
8979 int i;
8981 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
8982 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8983 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8984 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
8985 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
8987 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
8989 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
8990 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
8991 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
8992 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
8995 break;
8997 default:
8998 gcc_unreachable ();
9001 return loc_result;
9004 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
9005 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9006 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9007 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9008 the value of LOC. */
9010 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9011 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9013 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9014 int have_address = 0;
9015 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9017 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9018 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
9019 problem... */
9021 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9023 case ERROR_MARK:
9024 return 0;
9026 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9027 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9028 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9029 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9030 the names of types. */
9031 return 0;
9033 case CALL_EXPR:
9034 return 0;
9036 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9037 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9038 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9039 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9040 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9041 return 0;
9043 case ADDR_EXPR:
9044 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9045 if (want_address)
9046 return 0;
9048 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9049 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9051 case VAR_DECL:
9052 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9054 rtx rtl;
9056 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
9057 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9058 return 0;
9060 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9061 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
9062 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9063 return 0;
9065 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9066 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9067 return 0;
9069 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9070 return 0;
9071 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9072 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9073 return 0;
9075 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9076 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9077 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9079 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9080 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9082 have_address = 1;
9083 break;
9085 /* FALLTHRU */
9087 case PARM_DECL:
9088 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9089 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9090 want_address);
9091 /* FALLTHRU */
9093 case RESULT_DECL:
9095 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9097 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9098 return 0;
9099 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9101 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9102 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9103 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9104 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9106 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9107 return 0;
9108 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9110 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9111 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9112 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9114 else
9116 enum machine_mode mode;
9118 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9119 if (want_address == 2)
9120 return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9122 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9123 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9125 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9126 have_address = 1;
9128 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9131 break;
9133 case INDIRECT_REF:
9134 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9135 have_address = 1;
9136 break;
9138 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9139 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9141 case NOP_EXPR:
9142 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9143 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9144 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9145 case SAVE_EXPR:
9146 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9147 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9149 case COMPONENT_REF:
9150 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9151 case ARRAY_REF:
9152 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9154 tree obj, offset;
9155 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9156 enum machine_mode mode;
9157 int volatilep;
9158 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9160 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9161 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9163 if (obj == loc)
9164 return 0;
9166 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9167 if (ret == 0
9168 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9169 return 0;
9171 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9173 /* Variable offset. */
9174 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9175 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9178 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9179 if (bytepos > 0)
9180 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9181 else if (bytepos < 0)
9183 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9184 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9187 have_address = 1;
9188 break;
9191 case INTEGER_CST:
9192 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9193 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9194 else
9195 return 0;
9196 break;
9198 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9200 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9201 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9202 enum machine_mode mode;
9204 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9205 return 0;
9206 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9207 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9208 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9209 have_address = 1;
9210 break;
9213 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9214 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9215 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9216 op = DW_OP_and;
9217 goto do_binop;
9219 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9220 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9221 op = DW_OP_xor;
9222 goto do_binop;
9224 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9225 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9226 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9227 op = DW_OP_or;
9228 goto do_binop;
9230 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9231 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9232 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9233 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9234 op = DW_OP_div;
9235 goto do_binop;
9237 case MINUS_EXPR:
9238 op = DW_OP_minus;
9239 goto do_binop;
9241 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9242 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9243 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9244 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9245 op = DW_OP_mod;
9246 goto do_binop;
9248 case MULT_EXPR:
9249 op = DW_OP_mul;
9250 goto do_binop;
9252 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9253 op = DW_OP_shl;
9254 goto do_binop;
9256 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9257 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9258 goto do_binop;
9260 case PLUS_EXPR:
9261 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9262 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9264 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9265 if (ret == 0)
9266 return 0;
9268 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9269 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9270 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9272 0));
9273 break;
9276 op = DW_OP_plus;
9277 goto do_binop;
9279 case LE_EXPR:
9280 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9281 return 0;
9283 op = DW_OP_le;
9284 goto do_binop;
9286 case GE_EXPR:
9287 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9288 return 0;
9290 op = DW_OP_ge;
9291 goto do_binop;
9293 case LT_EXPR:
9294 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9295 return 0;
9297 op = DW_OP_lt;
9298 goto do_binop;
9300 case GT_EXPR:
9301 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9302 return 0;
9304 op = DW_OP_gt;
9305 goto do_binop;
9307 case EQ_EXPR:
9308 op = DW_OP_eq;
9309 goto do_binop;
9311 case NE_EXPR:
9312 op = DW_OP_ne;
9313 goto do_binop;
9315 do_binop:
9316 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9317 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9318 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9319 return 0;
9321 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9322 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9323 break;
9325 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9326 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9327 op = DW_OP_not;
9328 goto do_unop;
9330 case ABS_EXPR:
9331 op = DW_OP_abs;
9332 goto do_unop;
9334 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9335 op = DW_OP_neg;
9336 goto do_unop;
9338 do_unop:
9339 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9340 if (ret == 0)
9341 return 0;
9343 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9344 break;
9346 case MIN_EXPR:
9347 case MAX_EXPR:
9349 const enum tree_code code =
9350 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9352 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9353 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9354 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9355 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9358 /* ... fall through ... */
9360 case COND_EXPR:
9362 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9363 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9364 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9365 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9366 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9368 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9369 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9370 return 0;
9372 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9373 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9375 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9376 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9377 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9379 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9380 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9381 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9383 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9384 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9385 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9386 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9387 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9389 break;
9391 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9392 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9393 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9394 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9395 return 0;
9397 default:
9398 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9399 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9400 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9401 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9402 return 0;
9404 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9405 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9406 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9407 gcc_unreachable ();
9408 #else
9409 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9410 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9411 return NULL;
9412 #endif
9415 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9416 if (want_address && !have_address)
9417 return 0;
9419 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9420 if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9422 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9424 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9425 return 0;
9426 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9427 op = DW_OP_deref;
9428 else
9429 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9431 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9434 return ret;
9437 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9438 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9440 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9443 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9444 which is not less than the value itself. */
9446 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9447 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9449 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9452 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9453 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9454 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9455 ERROR_MARK node. */
9457 static inline tree
9458 field_type (tree decl)
9460 tree type;
9462 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9463 return integer_type_node;
9465 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9466 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9467 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9469 return type;
9472 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9473 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9474 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9476 static inline unsigned
9477 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9479 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9482 static inline unsigned
9483 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9485 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9488 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9489 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9490 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9491 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9492 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9493 just yet). */
9495 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9496 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9498 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9499 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9500 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9501 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9502 tree type;
9503 tree field_size_tree;
9504 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9505 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9506 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9508 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9509 return 0;
9511 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9513 type = field_type (decl);
9514 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9516 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9517 a flexible array member. */
9518 if (! field_size_tree)
9519 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9521 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9522 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9523 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9524 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9525 return 0;
9527 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9529 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9530 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9531 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9532 else
9533 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9535 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9536 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9537 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9539 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9540 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9541 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
9542 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9543 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9544 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
9545 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9546 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9548 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9550 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9551 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9552 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9553 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9554 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9555 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9556 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9557 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9558 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9559 bits of the bit-field itself.
9561 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9562 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
9563 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9564 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9565 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9566 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9567 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
9568 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9569 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9571 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9572 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9573 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9574 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9575 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9576 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
9578 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9579 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
9580 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9582 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9583 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
9584 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9586 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
9587 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9588 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9589 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9591 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9593 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
9594 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9596 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
9597 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9598 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9599 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9602 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9605 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9606 associated with them. */
9608 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9610 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9611 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9612 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
9614 static inline void
9615 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9616 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9618 if (descr != 0)
9619 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9622 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9623 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9624 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9625 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9626 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9627 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
9628 function above).
9630 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9631 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9632 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9633 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9634 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
9635 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9636 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
9637 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
9638 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9639 function below.) */
9641 static void
9642 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9644 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9645 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9647 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9649 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9650 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9652 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9653 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9654 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9655 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9657 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9659 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9661 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9663 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9664 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9665 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9667 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9668 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9669 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9671 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9672 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9673 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9675 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9676 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9677 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9678 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9680 /* Extract the offset. */
9681 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9682 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9684 /* Add it to the object address. */
9685 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9686 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9688 else
9689 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9691 else
9692 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9694 if (! loc_descr)
9696 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9698 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9699 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9700 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9702 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9703 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9704 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9705 stack. */
9706 op = DW_OP_constu;
9707 #else
9708 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9709 #endif
9711 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9714 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9717 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
9719 static void
9720 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9722 while (size != 0)
9724 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9725 val >>= 8;
9726 --size;
9730 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
9732 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9733 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9735 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9737 src += size;
9738 while (size != 0)
9740 val <<= 8;
9741 val |= *--src & 0xff;
9742 --size;
9744 return val;
9747 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
9749 static void
9750 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9752 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9753 long val[4];
9754 int i;
9756 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9757 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9759 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
9760 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9762 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9763 array += 4;
9767 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9768 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9769 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9770 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9771 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9773 static void
9774 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9776 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9778 case CONST_INT:
9780 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9782 if (val < 0)
9783 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9784 else
9785 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9787 break;
9789 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9790 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9791 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9792 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9793 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9795 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9797 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9799 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9800 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9802 insert_float (rtl, array);
9803 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9805 else
9807 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9808 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9810 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9811 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9814 break;
9816 case CONST_VECTOR:
9818 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9819 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9820 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9821 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9822 unsigned int i;
9823 unsigned char *p;
9825 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9827 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9828 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9830 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9831 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9833 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9835 case CONST_INT:
9836 lo = INTVAL (elt);
9837 hi = -(lo < 0);
9838 break;
9840 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9841 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9842 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9843 break;
9845 default:
9846 gcc_unreachable ();
9849 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9850 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9851 else
9853 unsigned char *p0 = p;
9854 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9856 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9857 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9859 p0 = p1;
9860 p1 = p;
9862 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9863 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9866 break;
9868 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9869 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9871 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9872 insert_float (elt, p);
9874 break;
9876 default:
9877 gcc_unreachable ();
9880 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9882 break;
9884 case CONST_STRING:
9885 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
9886 break;
9888 case SYMBOL_REF:
9889 case LABEL_REF:
9890 case CONST:
9891 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
9892 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
9893 break;
9895 case PLUS:
9896 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
9897 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
9898 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
9899 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
9900 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
9901 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
9902 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
9903 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
9904 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
9905 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
9906 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
9907 break;
9909 default:
9910 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
9911 gcc_unreachable ();
9916 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
9917 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
9918 output). */
9919 static tree
9920 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
9921 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9923 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
9924 *walk_subtrees = 0;
9926 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
9927 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
9928 return *tp;
9929 else
9930 return NULL_TREE;
9933 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
9934 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
9936 static rtx
9937 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
9939 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
9941 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
9942 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
9943 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9945 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
9946 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9947 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
9949 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
9950 && domain
9951 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
9952 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
9953 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
9954 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
9955 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
9956 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
9957 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
9959 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
9960 CONCAT: FIXME! */
9961 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
9963 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
9964 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
9965 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
9967 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
9968 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
9969 reference variables which won't be output. */
9970 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
9971 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
9973 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
9975 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
9976 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
9979 return rtl;
9982 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
9984 static rtx
9985 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
9987 rtx rtl;
9989 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
9990 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
9991 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
9993 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
9994 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
9995 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
9996 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
9997 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
9998 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
9999 referenced within the function.
10001 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10002 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10003 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10004 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10006 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10007 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
10008 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10009 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10010 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10011 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10013 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10014 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10015 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10016 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
10017 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10018 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10019 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10020 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10021 output at debug-time.
10023 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10024 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
10025 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
10026 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10027 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10028 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10029 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10030 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
10031 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10032 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10033 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10034 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10035 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10037 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10038 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10039 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
10040 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10041 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10042 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10043 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
10044 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10045 I'd like to fix it.
10047 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10048 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10049 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10050 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10051 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10052 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10053 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10054 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10055 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10056 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10057 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10059 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10060 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10062 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10063 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10064 fixed registers. */
10065 if (! reload_completed)
10067 if (rtl
10068 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10069 || (MEM_P (rtl)
10070 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10071 || (REG_P (rtl)
10072 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10073 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10075 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10076 return rtl;
10078 rtl = NULL_RTX;
10080 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10082 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10084 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10085 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10086 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10087 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10089 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10090 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10091 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10092 if (dmode == pmode)
10093 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10094 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10095 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10096 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10098 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10099 if (REG_P (inc))
10100 rtl = inc;
10101 else if (MEM_P (inc))
10103 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10104 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10105 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10106 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10107 else
10108 rtl = inc;
10113 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10114 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10115 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10116 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10117 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10118 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10119 thing to do. */
10120 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10121 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10122 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10123 /* Not passed in memory. */
10124 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10125 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10126 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10127 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10128 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10129 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10130 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10131 #endif
10133 /* Big endian correction check. */
10134 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10135 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10136 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10137 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10139 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10140 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10142 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10143 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10146 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10147 && rtl
10148 && MEM_P (rtl)
10149 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10150 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10152 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10153 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10155 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10156 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10157 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10158 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10159 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10160 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10161 if (rsize > dsize)
10162 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10163 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10166 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10167 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10168 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10169 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10170 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10172 if (rtl)
10173 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10175 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10176 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10177 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10178 if (rtl)
10179 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10181 return rtl;
10184 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10185 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10186 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10187 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10188 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10189 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10191 static const char *
10192 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10194 const char *secname;
10196 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10198 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10199 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10201 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10203 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10204 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10206 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10207 secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10208 else
10209 secname = text_section_label;
10211 return secname;
10214 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10215 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10216 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10217 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10218 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10219 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10220 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10221 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10222 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10223 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10225 static void
10226 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10227 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10229 rtx rtl;
10230 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10231 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10232 struct var_loc_node *node;
10233 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10234 return;
10236 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10237 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10239 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10240 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10242 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10243 differ. */
10244 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10246 const char *endname, *secname;
10247 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10248 rtx varloc;
10250 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10251 actually construct the list of locations.
10252 The first location information is what is passed to the
10253 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10254 locations just get added on to that list.
10255 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10256 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10257 the range [current location start, next location start].
10258 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10259 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10261 node = loc_list->first;
10262 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10263 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10265 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10266 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10267 node = node->next;
10269 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10270 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10272 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10273 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10274 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10275 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10276 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10279 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10280 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10281 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10283 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10285 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10286 if (!current_function_decl)
10287 endname = text_end_label;
10288 else
10290 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10291 current_function_funcdef_no);
10292 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10294 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10295 node->label, endname, secname);
10298 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10299 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10300 return;
10303 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10304 the location. */
10306 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10307 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10309 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10310 return;
10313 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10314 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10315 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10316 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10318 node = loc_list->first;
10319 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10320 if (descr)
10322 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10323 return;
10327 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10328 description from the tree. */
10329 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10330 if (descr)
10332 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10333 return;
10335 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10336 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
10337 tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
10340 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10341 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10342 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10344 static void
10345 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10347 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10348 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10349 rtx rtl;
10351 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10352 /* OK */;
10353 else
10354 return;
10356 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10357 if (rtl)
10358 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10361 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10362 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10363 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10364 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10365 expressions. */
10367 static dw_loc_list_ref
10368 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10370 dw_fde_ref fde;
10371 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10372 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10373 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10374 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10376 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10378 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10379 list_tail = &list;
10380 list = NULL;
10382 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10383 next_cfa.offset = 0;
10384 next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10385 next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10387 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10389 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10390 advance opcodes. */
10391 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10392 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10394 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10395 last_label = start_label;
10397 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10398 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10400 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10401 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10402 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10403 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10405 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10406 start_label, last_label, section,
10407 list == NULL);
10409 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10410 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10411 start_label = last_label;
10413 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10414 break;
10416 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10417 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
10418 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10419 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10420 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
10421 if it were to be required. */
10422 gcc_unreachable ();
10424 default:
10425 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10426 break;
10429 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10431 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10432 start_label, last_label, section,
10433 list == NULL);
10434 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10435 start_label = last_label;
10437 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10438 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10439 list == NULL);
10441 return list;
10444 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10445 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10446 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
10447 before the latter is negated. */
10449 static void
10450 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10452 rtx reg, elim;
10454 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10455 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10456 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10457 #else
10458 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10459 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10460 #endif
10462 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10463 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10465 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10466 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10468 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10469 : stack_pointer_rtx));
10471 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10474 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10475 the value of the attribute. */
10477 static void
10478 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10480 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10482 if (demangle_name_func)
10483 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10485 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10489 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
10491 static void
10492 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10494 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10495 if (wd != NULL)
10496 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10499 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10500 a representation for that bound. */
10502 static void
10503 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10505 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10507 case ERROR_MARK:
10508 return;
10510 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
10511 case INTEGER_CST:
10512 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10513 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10514 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
10515 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10516 /* Use the default. */
10518 else
10519 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10520 break;
10522 case CONVERT_EXPR:
10523 case NOP_EXPR:
10524 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10525 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10526 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10527 break;
10529 case SAVE_EXPR:
10530 break;
10532 case VAR_DECL:
10533 case PARM_DECL:
10534 case RESULT_DECL:
10536 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10538 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10539 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10540 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10541 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10542 later parameter. */
10543 if (decl_die != NULL)
10544 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10545 break;
10548 default:
10550 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10551 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
10553 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10554 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10556 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10557 if (loc == NULL)
10558 break;
10560 if (current_function_decl == 0)
10561 ctx = comp_unit_die;
10562 else
10563 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10565 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10566 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10567 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10568 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10570 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10571 break;
10576 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10577 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
10579 static void
10580 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10582 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10583 unsigned dimension_number;
10584 #endif
10585 tree lower, upper;
10586 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10588 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10589 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10590 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10591 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10592 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10593 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10594 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10595 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
10597 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10598 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10599 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10600 gen_array_type_die. */
10601 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10602 for (dimension_number = 0;
10603 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10604 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10605 #endif
10607 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10609 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10610 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
10611 here. */
10612 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10613 if (domain)
10615 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
10616 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10617 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10619 /* Define the index type. */
10620 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10622 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
10623 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
10624 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
10625 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10626 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10627 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10628 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10630 else
10631 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10632 type_die);
10635 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10636 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
10637 dimension arr(N:*)
10638 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10639 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10640 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
10642 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10643 if (upper)
10644 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10647 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
10648 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10649 bounds. */
10653 static void
10654 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10656 unsigned size;
10658 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10660 case ERROR_MARK:
10661 size = 0;
10662 break;
10663 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10664 case RECORD_TYPE:
10665 case UNION_TYPE:
10666 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10667 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10668 break;
10669 case FIELD_DECL:
10670 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10671 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10672 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
10673 even for bit-fields. */
10674 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10675 break;
10676 default:
10677 gcc_unreachable ();
10680 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
10681 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
10682 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
10683 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
10684 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
10687 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10688 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10689 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10690 bit-field itself.
10692 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10693 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10694 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10695 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
10696 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10697 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10699 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10700 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10701 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
10703 static inline void
10704 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10706 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10707 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10708 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10709 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10710 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10711 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10713 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10714 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10716 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10717 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10718 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
10719 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10720 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10721 return;
10723 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10725 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10726 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10727 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10728 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10729 below must take account of these differences. */
10730 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10731 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10733 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10735 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10736 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10739 bit_offset
10740 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10741 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10742 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10744 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10747 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10748 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
10750 static inline void
10751 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10753 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10754 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10755 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10757 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10758 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10761 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10762 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
10764 static inline void
10765 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10767 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10768 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10769 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10772 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
10773 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10774 equate table. */
10776 static inline void
10777 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10779 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10781 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10783 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10784 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10785 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10787 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10788 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
10789 tree fn = origin;
10791 if (TYPE_P (fn))
10792 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10794 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10795 if (fn)
10796 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10799 if (DECL_P (origin))
10800 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10801 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10802 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10804 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10805 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10806 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10807 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
10808 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10809 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
10810 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10811 here. */
10813 if (origin_die)
10814 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10817 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
10819 static inline void
10820 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10822 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10824 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10826 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
10827 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
10828 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
10829 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
10830 0));
10832 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
10833 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10834 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10835 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
10839 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
10841 static void
10842 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10844 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
10845 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
10847 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10848 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
10851 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
10852 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
10854 static void
10855 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10857 tree decl_name;
10859 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
10860 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
10862 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
10863 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10864 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
10866 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
10867 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10868 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
10869 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
10870 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
10871 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
10872 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
10875 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10876 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
10877 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
10878 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
10880 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
10881 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10882 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10884 #endif
10887 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
10889 static void
10890 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
10892 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
10895 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
10897 static inline void
10898 pop_decl_scope (void)
10900 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
10903 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
10904 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
10905 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
10906 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
10907 the current active scope. */
10909 static dw_die_ref
10910 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
10912 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
10913 tree containing_scope;
10914 int i;
10916 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
10917 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
10919 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
10921 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
10922 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10924 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
10925 /* OK */;
10926 else
10927 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10930 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
10931 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
10932 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
10933 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
10934 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10936 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
10937 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10938 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
10940 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
10941 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
10942 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
10943 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10944 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
10945 break;
10947 if (i < 0)
10949 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
10950 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
10952 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
10953 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10955 else
10956 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
10958 else
10959 scope_die = context_die;
10961 return scope_die;
10964 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
10966 static inline int
10967 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10969 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
10970 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
10971 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10972 return 1;
10974 return 0;
10977 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
10978 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
10980 static inline int
10981 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10983 return (context_die
10984 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10985 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
10986 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
10989 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
10990 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
10991 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
10993 static void
10994 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
10995 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
10997 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
10998 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
11000 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
11001 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
11002 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
11003 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
11004 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
11005 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11006 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11008 if (code == ERROR_MARK
11009 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
11010 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
11011 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
11012 || code == VOID_TYPE)
11013 return;
11015 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11016 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11017 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11018 context_die);
11020 if (type_die != NULL)
11021 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11024 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11025 function call type. */
11026 static void
11027 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11029 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11031 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11033 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11034 is not DW_CC_normal. */
11035 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11036 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11039 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11040 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11041 was declared without a tag. */
11043 static const char *
11044 type_tag (tree type)
11046 const char *name = 0;
11048 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11050 tree t = 0;
11052 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11053 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11054 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11056 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11057 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11058 involved. */
11059 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11060 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11061 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11063 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11064 if (t != 0)
11065 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11068 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11071 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11072 for bit field types. */
11074 static inline tree
11075 member_declared_type (tree member)
11077 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11078 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11081 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11082 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11084 #if 0
11085 static const char *
11086 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11088 rtx x;
11089 const char *fnname;
11091 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11092 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11094 x = XEXP (x, 0);
11095 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11097 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11098 return fnname;
11100 #endif
11102 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11103 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11104 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11106 static void
11107 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11109 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11110 dw_die_ref array_die;
11111 tree element_type;
11113 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11114 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11115 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11116 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11117 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11118 #endif
11120 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11121 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11122 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11124 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11126 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11127 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11128 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11129 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11132 #if 0
11133 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11134 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11135 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11136 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11137 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11138 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11139 for multidimensional arrays. */
11140 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11141 #endif
11143 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11144 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11145 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11146 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11147 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11148 else
11149 #endif
11150 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11152 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11153 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11155 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11156 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11157 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11158 add_subscript_info. */
11159 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11160 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11161 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11163 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11164 #endif
11166 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11169 #if 0
11170 static void
11171 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11173 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11174 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11176 if (origin != NULL)
11177 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11178 else
11180 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11181 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11182 0, 0, context_die);
11185 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11186 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11187 else
11188 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11190 #endif
11192 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11193 emit full debugging info for them. */
11195 static void
11196 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11198 int i;
11200 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11201 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11204 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
11206 static void
11207 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11209 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11211 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11212 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11213 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11216 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
11218 static void
11219 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11221 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11223 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11224 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11225 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11228 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11230 static void
11231 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11233 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11235 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11236 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11237 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11240 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11241 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11242 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11243 DIE. */
11245 static dw_die_ref
11246 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11248 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11250 if (type_die == NULL)
11252 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11253 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11254 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11255 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11257 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11258 return type_die;
11259 else
11260 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11262 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
11263 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11264 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
11265 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11267 tree link;
11269 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11270 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11271 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11272 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11274 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11275 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11276 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11277 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11279 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11280 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11282 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11283 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11285 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11286 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11288 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11289 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11290 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
11291 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11292 values as if they were signed. That means that
11293 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11294 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
11295 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11296 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11299 else
11300 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11302 return type_die;
11305 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11306 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11307 type.
11309 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11310 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11311 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11312 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11313 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
11314 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11315 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11316 argument type of some subprogram type. */
11318 static dw_die_ref
11319 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11321 dw_die_ref parm_die
11322 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11323 tree origin;
11325 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11327 case tcc_declaration:
11328 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11329 if (origin != NULL)
11330 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11331 else
11333 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11334 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11335 TREE_READONLY (node),
11336 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11337 context_die);
11338 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11339 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11342 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11343 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11344 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11346 break;
11348 case tcc_type:
11349 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
11350 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11351 break;
11353 default:
11354 gcc_unreachable ();
11357 return parm_die;
11360 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11361 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
11363 static void
11364 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11366 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11369 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11370 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11371 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11372 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
11374 static void
11375 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11377 tree link;
11378 tree formal_type = NULL;
11379 tree first_parm_type;
11380 tree arg;
11382 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11384 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11385 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11387 else
11388 arg = NULL_TREE;
11390 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11392 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11393 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
11394 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11396 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11398 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11399 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11400 break;
11402 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
11403 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11404 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11405 && link == first_parm_type)
11406 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11407 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11409 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11410 if (arg)
11411 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11414 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11415 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
11416 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11417 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11419 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11420 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
11421 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11422 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11423 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11424 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11427 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11428 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11429 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
11430 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11431 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
11433 static void
11434 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11436 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11438 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11439 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
11440 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11441 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11443 dw_die_ref type_die;
11444 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11446 push_decl_scope (type);
11447 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11448 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11449 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11450 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11452 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11453 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
11454 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11455 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11456 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11458 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11459 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11462 else
11463 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11465 pop_decl_scope ();
11469 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11470 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
11472 static void
11473 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11475 dw_die_ref old_die;
11476 tree save_fn;
11477 struct function *save_cfun;
11478 tree context;
11479 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11481 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
11482 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11484 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11485 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11486 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
11487 return;
11489 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11490 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
11491 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11493 context = decl_class_context (decl);
11494 if (context)
11495 gen_type_die_for_member
11496 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11499 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
11500 save_fn = current_function_decl;
11501 save_cfun = cfun;
11502 current_function_decl = decl;
11503 cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
11505 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11506 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11507 if (! was_abstract)
11508 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11510 current_function_decl = save_fn;
11511 cfun = save_cfun;
11514 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
11515 htab_traverse_resize().
11517 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
11518 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
11519 static int
11520 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11522 tree type;
11523 dw_die_ref die;
11525 type = *slot;
11526 die = lookup_type_die (type);
11527 if (die != NULL)
11528 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
11529 return 1;
11532 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
11533 static void
11534 premark_used_types (void)
11536 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
11537 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
11540 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11541 block-local). */
11543 static void
11544 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11546 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11547 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11548 dw_die_ref subr_die;
11549 tree fn_arg_types;
11550 tree outer_scope;
11551 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11552 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11553 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11555 premark_used_types ();
11557 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11558 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11559 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11560 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11561 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
11563 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
11564 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11566 origin = NULL;
11567 gcc_assert (!old_die);
11570 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11571 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
11572 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11573 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11574 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11575 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11576 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11578 if (origin != NULL)
11580 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11582 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11583 inline function. */
11584 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11585 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11587 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11588 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11590 else if (old_die)
11592 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11593 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11595 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11596 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11597 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11598 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
11599 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11601 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11602 something we have already output. */
11603 return;
11606 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11607 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
11608 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11609 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
11610 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11611 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
11612 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
11613 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11614 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11615 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11616 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11617 == (unsigned) s.line))))
11619 subr_die = old_die;
11621 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11622 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11623 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11624 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11625 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
11626 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11627 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11629 else
11631 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11632 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11633 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11634 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11635 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11636 != (unsigned) s.line)
11637 add_AT_unsigned
11638 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11641 else
11643 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11645 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11646 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11648 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11649 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11651 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11652 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11653 0, 0, context_die);
11656 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11657 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11658 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11660 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11661 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11662 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11663 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11666 if (declaration)
11668 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11670 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11672 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11673 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
11674 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
11675 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
11677 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11678 later reused to represent definition. */
11679 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11682 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11684 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11686 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11687 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11688 else
11689 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11691 else
11693 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11694 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11695 else
11696 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11699 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11701 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11703 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11705 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11706 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11708 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11710 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11711 current_function_funcdef_no);
11712 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11713 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11714 current_function_funcdef_no);
11715 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11717 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11718 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11720 else
11721 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11722 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11723 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
11725 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11726 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11727 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11728 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11730 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11731 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11732 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11736 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11737 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
11738 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11739 #endif
11741 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11743 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
11744 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11745 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11746 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11747 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11748 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11749 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11750 function. */
11751 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11752 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
11753 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11754 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
11756 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11757 if (list->dw_loc_next)
11758 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11759 else
11760 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11763 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11764 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11765 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11766 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11767 by this displacement. */
11768 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11770 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11771 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11772 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11775 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11776 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11777 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11778 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
11779 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11780 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
11781 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11782 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11783 an ellipsis at the end. */
11785 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11786 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11787 its formal parameters. */
11788 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11790 else if (declaration)
11791 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11792 else
11794 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
11795 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11796 tree parm;
11798 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11799 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11800 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11801 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11803 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11804 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11805 "__builtin_va_alist"))
11806 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11807 else
11808 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11811 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11812 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11813 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11814 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11815 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
11816 parameters at all. */
11817 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11818 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11820 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
11821 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11822 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11824 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11825 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11828 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
11829 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
11830 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11832 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
11833 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
11834 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
11835 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
11836 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
11837 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
11838 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
11840 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
11841 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
11842 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
11843 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
11844 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
11845 constructor function. */
11846 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
11848 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
11849 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
11850 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
11852 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
11853 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
11855 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11856 if (current_function_has_inlines)
11858 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11859 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
11861 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11862 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
11865 #endif
11867 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
11868 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11872 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
11874 static void
11875 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11877 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11878 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
11880 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11881 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
11882 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
11883 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
11884 might end up being no definition anywhere in
11885 the program. For example, consider the C++
11886 test case:
11888 template <class T>
11889 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
11891 template <class T>
11892 const int S<T>::i;
11894 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
11896 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
11897 definition is required, so the compiler will
11898 not emit a definition. */
11899 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
11900 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11901 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11903 if (origin != NULL)
11904 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
11906 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
11907 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
11909 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
11910 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
11911 sharing them.
11913 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
11915 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
11916 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
11917 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
11918 declaration. */
11919 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
11920 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
11922 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
11923 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
11924 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
11926 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11927 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11929 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11930 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11932 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11933 != (unsigned) s.line)
11935 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11938 else
11940 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
11941 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
11942 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
11944 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11945 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11947 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11948 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11950 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11951 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11952 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11953 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11956 if (declaration)
11957 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11959 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
11960 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
11962 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11964 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
11965 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
11967 else
11968 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
11971 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
11973 static void
11974 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11976 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11977 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
11978 rtx insn;
11979 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11981 if (origin != NULL)
11982 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
11983 else
11984 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
11986 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11987 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
11988 else
11990 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
11992 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
11993 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
11994 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
11995 if (insn
11996 && (LABEL_P (insn)
11997 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
11998 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12000 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12001 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12002 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12003 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12004 it if it ever does happen. */
12005 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12007 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12008 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12013 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
12014 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12015 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
12017 static inline void
12018 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12020 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12021 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12023 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_file, file_index);
12024 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12027 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12028 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
12030 static inline void
12031 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12033 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12035 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
12037 tree chain;
12039 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
12041 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12044 add_ranges (chain);
12045 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12047 while (chain);
12048 add_ranges (NULL);
12050 else
12052 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12053 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12054 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12055 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12056 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12057 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12061 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
12063 static void
12064 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12066 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12068 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12069 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12071 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12074 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
12076 static void
12077 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12079 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12081 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
12082 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12083 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12084 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
12085 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12087 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12089 dw_die_ref subr_die
12090 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12092 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12093 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12094 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12096 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12097 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12099 else
12100 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12101 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
12102 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12103 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12104 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12105 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
12106 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
12107 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12108 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12109 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12110 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12111 intended :-) */
12112 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12115 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
12117 static void
12118 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12120 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12122 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12123 return;
12125 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12126 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12127 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12128 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12129 context_die);
12131 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12133 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12134 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12135 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12138 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12139 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12141 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12142 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12144 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12145 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12146 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12147 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12149 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
12150 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12153 #if 0
12154 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12155 Use modified_type_die instead.
12156 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12157 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12159 static void
12160 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12162 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12163 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12165 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12166 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12167 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12170 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12171 Use modified_type_die instead.
12172 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12173 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12175 static void
12176 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12178 dw_die_ref ref_die
12179 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12181 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12182 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12183 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12185 #endif
12187 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
12189 static void
12190 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12192 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12193 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12194 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12196 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12197 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12198 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12199 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12202 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
12204 static dw_die_ref
12205 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12207 dw_die_ref die;
12208 char producer[250];
12209 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12210 int language;
12212 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12214 if (filename)
12216 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12217 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
12218 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12219 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12222 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12224 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12225 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12226 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12227 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12228 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12229 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12230 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
12231 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12232 strcat (producer, " -g");
12233 #endif
12235 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12237 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12238 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12239 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12240 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12241 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12242 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12243 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12244 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12245 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12246 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12247 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12248 language = DW_LANG_Java;
12249 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
12250 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
12251 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
12252 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
12253 else
12254 language = DW_LANG_C89;
12256 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12257 return die;
12260 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
12262 static void
12263 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12265 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12267 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12268 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12270 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12271 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12273 if (access == access_public_node)
12274 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12275 else if (access == access_protected_node)
12276 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12279 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
12281 static void
12282 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12284 tree member;
12285 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12286 dw_die_ref child;
12288 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12289 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12290 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12291 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12292 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12293 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12294 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12295 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
12296 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12297 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12298 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
12300 /* First output info about the base classes. */
12301 if (binfo)
12303 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12304 int i;
12305 tree base;
12307 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12308 gen_inheritance_die (base,
12309 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12310 : access_public_node), context_die);
12313 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
12314 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12316 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12317 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12318 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
12319 do put them in the right order. */
12321 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12322 if (child)
12323 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12324 else
12325 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12328 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
12329 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12331 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
12332 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12333 continue;
12335 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12336 if (child)
12337 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12338 else
12339 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12343 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12344 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12345 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
12347 static void
12348 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12350 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12351 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12352 int nested = 0;
12353 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12354 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12355 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12356 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12358 if (type_die && ! complete)
12359 return;
12361 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12362 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12363 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12364 nested = 1;
12366 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12368 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12369 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
12371 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12373 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12374 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12375 scope_die, type);
12376 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12377 if (old_die)
12378 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12379 else
12380 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12382 else
12383 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12385 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12386 then give a list of members. */
12387 if (complete && !ns_decl)
12389 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12390 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
12391 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12392 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12393 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12394 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12396 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12397 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12398 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12399 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12401 push_decl_scope (type);
12402 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12403 pop_decl_scope ();
12405 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
12406 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12408 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12410 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12411 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12412 lookup_type_die (vtype));
12415 else
12417 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12419 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
12420 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12421 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12422 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12426 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
12428 static void
12429 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12431 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12432 dw_die_ref subr_die
12433 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12434 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12436 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12437 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12438 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12439 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12442 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
12444 static void
12445 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12447 dw_die_ref type_die;
12448 tree origin;
12450 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12451 return;
12453 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12454 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12455 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12456 if (origin != NULL)
12457 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12458 else
12460 tree type;
12462 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12463 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12465 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12467 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12468 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12470 else
12471 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12473 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12474 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12477 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12478 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12481 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
12483 static void
12484 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12486 int need_pop;
12488 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12489 return;
12491 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12492 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12494 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12495 return;
12497 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
12498 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12500 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12501 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12502 return;
12505 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12506 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12507 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12508 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12509 cloned type itself). */
12510 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12511 type = type_main_variant (type);
12513 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12514 return;
12516 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12518 case ERROR_MARK:
12519 break;
12521 case POINTER_TYPE:
12522 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12523 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
12524 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12525 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
12526 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12527 statement. */
12528 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12530 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12531 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
12532 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12533 break;
12535 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12536 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12537 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
12538 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
12540 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
12541 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12543 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12544 itself. */
12545 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12546 break;
12548 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12549 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12550 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12551 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12552 break;
12554 case METHOD_TYPE:
12555 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12556 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12557 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12558 break;
12560 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12561 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12562 break;
12564 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12565 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12566 break;
12568 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12569 case RECORD_TYPE:
12570 case UNION_TYPE:
12571 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12572 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12573 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
12574 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12575 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
12576 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12577 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
12578 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12579 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12580 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12582 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
12584 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12585 return;
12587 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
12588 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12589 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12590 need_pop = 1;
12592 else
12594 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12595 need_pop = 0;
12598 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12599 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12600 else
12601 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12603 if (need_pop)
12604 pop_decl_scope ();
12606 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12607 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12608 when appropriate. */
12609 return;
12611 case VOID_TYPE:
12612 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12613 case REAL_TYPE:
12614 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12615 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12616 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
12617 break;
12619 case LANG_TYPE:
12620 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
12621 break;
12623 default:
12624 gcc_unreachable ();
12627 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12630 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
12632 static void
12633 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12635 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12636 return;
12638 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12639 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12640 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12641 type now. */
12642 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12644 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12645 an instance of an unresolved type. */
12647 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12649 case ERROR_MARK:
12650 break;
12652 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12653 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12654 break;
12656 case RECORD_TYPE:
12657 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12658 break;
12660 case UNION_TYPE:
12661 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12662 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12663 break;
12665 default:
12666 gcc_unreachable ();
12670 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12671 things which are local to the given block. */
12673 static void
12674 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12676 int must_output_die = 0;
12677 tree origin;
12678 tree decl;
12679 enum tree_code origin_code;
12681 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
12682 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12683 return;
12685 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12686 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12687 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
12688 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12690 tree sub;
12692 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12693 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12695 return;
12698 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
12699 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12700 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12701 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12702 the current block. */
12703 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12704 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12706 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12707 block. */
12708 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12709 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
12710 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
12711 must_output_die = 1;
12712 else
12714 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12715 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12716 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12717 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12718 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
12719 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12720 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
12721 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12723 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12724 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
12725 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12726 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12727 as being a "significant" one. */
12728 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12729 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12730 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12731 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12732 else
12733 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12734 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
12735 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12736 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12737 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12738 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12740 must_output_die = 1;
12741 break;
12746 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12747 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12748 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12749 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12750 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12751 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12752 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
12753 if (must_output_die)
12755 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12756 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12757 else
12758 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12760 else
12761 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12764 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12765 all of its sub-blocks. */
12767 static void
12768 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12770 tree decl;
12771 tree subblocks;
12773 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
12774 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12775 return;
12777 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12779 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12780 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12781 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12782 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
12783 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12785 dw_die_ref die;
12787 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12788 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12789 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12790 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12791 else
12792 die = NULL;
12794 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12795 add_child_die (context_die, die);
12796 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
12797 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
12798 in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
12799 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
12801 else
12802 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12806 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
12807 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12808 return;
12810 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
12811 therein) of this block. */
12812 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
12813 subblocks != NULL;
12814 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
12815 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
12818 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
12820 static inline int
12821 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
12823 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12824 return 1;
12826 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
12827 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
12828 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
12829 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
12830 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
12831 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
12832 return 1;
12834 return 0;
12837 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
12839 static dw_die_ref
12840 force_decl_die (tree decl)
12842 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12843 unsigned saved_external_flag;
12844 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
12845 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12846 if (!decl_die)
12848 dw_die_ref context_die;
12849 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
12850 if (decl_context)
12852 /* Find die that represents this context. */
12853 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
12854 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
12855 else
12856 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
12858 else
12859 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12861 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12862 if (decl_die)
12863 return decl_die;
12865 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12867 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12868 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
12869 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
12870 declaration die. */
12871 save_fn = current_function_decl;
12872 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
12873 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
12874 current_function_decl = save_fn;
12875 break;
12877 case VAR_DECL:
12878 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
12879 gen_decl_die() call. */
12880 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
12881 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
12882 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12883 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
12884 break;
12886 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
12887 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12888 break;
12890 default:
12891 gcc_unreachable ();
12894 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
12895 if (!decl_die)
12896 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12897 gcc_assert (decl_die);
12900 return decl_die;
12903 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE. A DIE is always returned. */
12905 static dw_die_ref
12906 force_type_die (tree type)
12908 dw_die_ref type_die;
12910 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12911 if (!type_die)
12913 dw_die_ref context_die;
12914 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12916 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12917 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12918 else
12919 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12921 else
12922 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12924 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12925 if (type_die)
12926 return type_die;
12927 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12928 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12929 gcc_assert (type_die);
12931 return type_die;
12934 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
12935 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
12937 static dw_die_ref
12938 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12940 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
12941 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
12942 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
12943 /* Force out the namespace. */
12944 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
12946 return context_die;
12949 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
12950 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
12952 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
12953 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
12955 static void
12956 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12958 dw_die_ref ns_context;
12960 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12961 return;
12963 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
12964 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
12965 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
12966 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
12967 return;
12969 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
12971 if (ns_context != context_die)
12973 if (DECL_P (thing))
12974 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
12975 else
12976 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
12980 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
12982 static void
12983 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
12985 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
12987 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
12988 they are an alias of. */
12989 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
12991 /* Output a real namespace. */
12992 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12993 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
12994 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12995 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12997 else
12999 /* Output a namespace alias. */
13001 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
13002 dw_die_ref origin_die
13003 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13005 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
13006 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13007 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
13008 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13009 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
13010 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13014 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
13016 static void
13017 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13019 tree origin;
13021 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13022 return;
13024 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13026 case ERROR_MARK:
13027 break;
13029 case CONST_DECL:
13030 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13031 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
13032 break;
13034 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13035 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13036 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
13037 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
13038 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
13039 break;
13041 #if 0
13042 /* FIXME */
13043 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13044 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
13045 if (current_function_decl != decl)
13046 /* This is only a declaration. */;
13047 #endif
13049 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
13050 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13051 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13053 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13054 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
13055 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13056 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13057 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13058 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13059 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13060 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
13061 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13063 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13064 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13067 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
13068 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13070 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13071 have described its return type. */
13072 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13074 /* And its virtual context. */
13075 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13076 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13078 /* And its containing type. */
13079 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13080 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13081 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13083 /* And its containing namespace. */
13084 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13087 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
13088 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13089 break;
13091 case TYPE_DECL:
13092 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13093 actual typedefs. */
13094 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13095 break;
13097 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13098 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13099 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13100 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13101 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13102 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
13103 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13105 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13106 break;
13109 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13110 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13111 else
13112 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
13113 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13114 break;
13116 case LABEL_DECL:
13117 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13118 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13119 break;
13121 case VAR_DECL:
13122 case RESULT_DECL:
13123 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13124 variable declarations or definitions. */
13125 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13126 break;
13128 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13129 object. */
13130 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13132 /* And its containing type. */
13133 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13134 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13135 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13137 /* And its containing namespace. */
13138 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13140 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
13141 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13142 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13143 function. */
13144 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13145 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13146 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13147 else
13148 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13149 break;
13151 case FIELD_DECL:
13152 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13153 anonymous unions and structs. */
13154 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13155 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13156 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13158 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13159 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13161 break;
13163 case PARM_DECL:
13164 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13165 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13166 break;
13168 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13169 gen_namespace_die (decl);
13170 break;
13172 default:
13173 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
13174 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13175 break;
13179 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
13180 compilation proper has finished. */
13182 static void
13183 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13185 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13186 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13187 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13188 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
13189 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13190 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13193 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
13194 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
13195 static void
13196 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13198 if (!local)
13199 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13202 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
13204 static void
13205 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13207 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13208 dw_die_ref scope_die;
13209 unsigned file_index;
13210 expanded_location xloc;
13212 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13213 return;
13215 gcc_assert (decl);
13217 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13218 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13219 itself. */
13221 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13222 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
13223 if (!context)
13224 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13225 else if (TYPE_P (context))
13226 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13227 else
13228 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13230 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
13231 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13232 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13233 else
13235 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13236 if (!at_import_die)
13238 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13239 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
13240 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13242 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13243 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13245 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13246 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13247 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13248 else
13249 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13250 else
13251 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13252 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13254 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13258 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
13259 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13260 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13261 else
13262 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13264 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13265 file_index = lookup_filename (xloc.file);
13266 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
13267 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13268 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13271 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
13273 void
13274 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13276 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13278 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13280 case ERROR_MARK:
13281 return;
13283 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13284 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13285 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13286 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13287 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13288 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13289 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13290 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
13291 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13292 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13293 with the definition of the function.
13295 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13296 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13297 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13298 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13299 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
13300 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13301 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13302 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13303 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13304 that they *are* definitions).
13306 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13307 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13308 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13309 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13310 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
13311 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13312 return;
13314 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13315 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
13316 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
13317 if (decl_function_context (decl)
13318 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
13319 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13320 context_die = NULL;
13321 break;
13323 case VAR_DECL:
13324 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13325 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13326 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
13327 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13328 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
13329 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13330 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13331 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
13332 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13333 return;
13335 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
13336 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13337 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13339 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13340 variable declarations or definitions. */
13341 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13342 return;
13343 break;
13345 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13346 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13347 return;
13348 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13349 return;
13350 break;
13352 case TYPE_DECL:
13353 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
13354 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13355 return;
13357 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13358 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
13359 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13361 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13362 comparisons have. */
13363 if (is_cxx ()
13364 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13365 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13366 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13368 return;
13371 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
13372 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13373 return;
13375 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13376 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
13377 if (decl_function_context (decl))
13378 context_die = NULL;
13380 break;
13382 default:
13383 return;
13386 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13389 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13390 a lexical block. */
13392 static void
13393 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13394 unsigned int blocknum)
13396 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13397 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13400 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13401 lexical block. */
13403 static void
13404 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13406 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13407 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13410 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13411 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13413 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13414 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13415 we may end up calling them anyway. */
13417 static bool
13418 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13420 tree decl;
13422 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13423 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13424 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13425 return 0;
13427 return 1;
13430 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13431 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
13432 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
13433 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13434 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13435 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
13436 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13437 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
13438 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
13439 all searches. */
13441 static unsigned
13442 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13444 size_t i, n;
13445 char *save_file_name;
13447 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13448 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
13449 if (file_table_last_lookup_index != 0)
13451 const char *last
13452 = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, file_table_last_lookup_index);
13453 if (strcmp (file_name, last) == 0)
13454 return file_table_last_lookup_index;
13457 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
13458 n = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table);
13459 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
13460 if (strcmp (file_name, VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)) == 0)
13462 file_table_last_lookup_index = i;
13463 return i;
13466 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
13467 file_table_last_lookup_index = n;
13468 save_file_name = (char *) ggc_strdup (file_name);
13469 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, save_file_name);
13470 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13472 /* If the assembler is emitting the file table, and we aren't eliminating
13473 unused debug types, then we must emit .file here. If we are eliminating
13474 unused debug types, then this will be done by the maybe_emit_file call in
13475 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs. */
13477 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && ! flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
13478 return maybe_emit_file (i);
13480 return i;
13483 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13484 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13485 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
13486 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13487 types, which may include filenames. */
13489 static int
13490 maybe_emit_file (int fileno)
13492 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && fileno > 0)
13494 if (!VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno))
13496 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno) = ++emitcount;
13497 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ",
13498 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno));
13499 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
13500 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, fileno));
13501 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13503 return VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno);
13505 else
13506 return fileno;
13509 /* Initialize the compiler internal file table. */
13511 static void
13512 init_file_table (void)
13514 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
13515 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR_INIT (file_table, 64, "file_table");
13516 VARRAY_UINT_INIT (file_table_emitted, 64, "file_table_emitted");
13518 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
13519 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, NULL);
13520 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13521 file_table_last_lookup_index = 0;
13524 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
13525 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13526 our lookup table. */
13528 static void
13529 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13531 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13532 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13533 rtx prev_insn;
13534 static rtx last_insn;
13535 static const char *last_label;
13536 tree decl;
13538 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13539 return;
13540 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13542 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13543 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13544 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13545 last time. */
13546 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13547 && last_insn == prev_insn
13548 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13549 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13551 newloc->label = last_label;
13553 else
13555 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13556 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13557 loclabel_num++;
13558 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13560 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13561 newloc->next = NULL;
13563 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13564 newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13565 else
13566 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13568 last_insn = loc_note;
13569 last_label = newloc->label;
13570 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13571 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13574 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13575 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13576 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13577 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
13579 static void
13580 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13582 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13584 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13585 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13588 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13589 and record information relating to this source line, in
13590 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
13592 static void
13593 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13595 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13596 && line != 0)
13598 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13600 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
13601 if (flag_debug_asm)
13602 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13603 filename, line);
13605 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13607 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13609 file_num = maybe_emit_file (file_num);
13611 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
13612 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13614 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
13615 line_info_table_in_use++;
13617 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13619 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13620 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13621 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13623 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13624 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13625 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13627 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13628 separate_line_info_table
13629 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13630 separate_line_info_table_allocated
13631 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13632 memset (separate_line_info_table
13633 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13635 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13636 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13639 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13640 line_info
13641 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13642 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13643 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13644 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13646 else
13648 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13650 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13651 line_info_table_in_use);
13653 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13654 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13656 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13657 line_info_table
13658 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13659 (line_info_table_allocated
13660 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13661 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13662 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13665 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13666 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13667 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13668 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13673 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
13675 static void
13676 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13678 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13680 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
13681 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13683 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13684 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13687 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13689 int fileno;
13691 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13692 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13693 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13694 lineno);
13696 fileno = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13697 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (fileno, "Filename we just started");
13701 /* Record the end of a source file. */
13703 static void
13704 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13706 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13707 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
13708 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13710 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13712 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13713 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13717 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13718 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13719 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13721 static void
13722 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13723 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13725 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13727 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13728 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13729 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13730 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13734 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13735 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13736 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13738 static void
13739 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13740 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13742 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13744 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13745 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13746 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13747 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13751 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
13753 static void
13754 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13756 init_file_table ();
13758 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
13759 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13760 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13762 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
13763 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13764 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13766 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
13767 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13769 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
13770 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13771 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13772 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13773 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13774 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13776 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
13777 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13778 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13779 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13781 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13782 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13784 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
13785 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13786 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13787 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13788 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
13789 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
13790 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
13792 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
13794 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
13796 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
13797 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13798 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
13799 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13800 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
13801 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13802 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
13803 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13804 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
13805 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13806 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
13807 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13808 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
13809 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13810 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
13811 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
13812 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
13813 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13814 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
13815 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13817 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13818 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
13819 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13820 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13821 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
13822 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13823 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13825 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
13826 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13827 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
13828 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13829 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
13830 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13831 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
13832 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
13833 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
13834 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
13835 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
13836 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
13838 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13840 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13841 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
13842 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13843 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
13846 switch_to_section (text_section);
13847 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
13848 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
13850 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
13851 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
13855 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
13856 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
13858 static int
13859 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13861 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
13863 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
13865 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
13866 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
13867 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
13870 return 1;
13873 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
13874 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
13876 static void
13877 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
13879 dw_die_ref c;
13881 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
13882 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
13884 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
13886 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
13887 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
13889 static void
13890 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
13892 dw_die_ref c;
13894 if (die->die_mark)
13895 die->die_mark = 0;
13896 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
13899 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
13900 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
13902 static void
13903 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
13905 dw_attr_ref a;
13906 unsigned ix;
13908 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
13910 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
13912 /* A reference to another DIE.
13913 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
13914 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
13916 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_file)
13918 /* A reference to a file. Make sure the file name is emitted. */
13919 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned =
13920 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
13922 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
13923 accounts properly for it. */
13924 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
13925 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
13930 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
13931 to DIE's children. */
13933 static void
13934 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
13936 dw_die_ref c;
13938 if (die->die_mark == 0)
13940 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
13941 die->die_mark = 1;
13943 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
13944 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
13945 if (die->die_parent)
13946 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
13948 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
13949 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13951 /* If this node is a specification,
13952 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
13953 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
13954 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
13957 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
13959 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
13960 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
13961 die->die_mark = 2;
13963 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
13964 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
13965 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
13966 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
13967 else
13968 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
13973 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
13975 static void
13976 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
13978 dw_die_ref c;
13980 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
13981 if (die->die_mark)
13982 return;
13984 switch (die->die_tag) {
13985 case DW_TAG_const_type:
13986 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
13987 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
13988 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
13989 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
13990 case DW_TAG_typedef:
13991 case DW_TAG_array_type:
13992 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
13993 case DW_TAG_union_type:
13994 case DW_TAG_class_type:
13995 case DW_TAG_friend:
13996 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
13997 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
13998 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
13999 case DW_TAG_string_type:
14000 case DW_TAG_set_type:
14001 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
14002 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
14003 case DW_TAG_file_type:
14004 if (die->die_perennial_p)
14005 break;
14007 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
14008 return;
14010 default:
14011 /* Mark everything else. */
14012 break;
14015 die->die_mark = 1;
14017 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
14018 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14020 /* Mark children. */
14021 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14024 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14025 attributes. */
14027 static void
14028 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
14030 dw_attr_ref a;
14031 unsigned ix;
14033 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14034 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14036 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
14037 s->refcount++;
14038 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14039 twice in the hash table. */
14040 if (s->refcount
14041 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
14043 void ** slot;
14044 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
14045 htab_hash_string (s->str),
14046 INSERT);
14047 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
14048 *slot = s;
14053 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
14055 static void
14056 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
14058 dw_die_ref c;
14060 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
14061 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
14063 if (! die->die_child)
14064 return;
14066 c = die->die_child;
14067 do {
14068 dw_die_ref prev = c;
14069 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
14070 if (c == die->die_child)
14072 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
14073 if (prev == c)
14074 /* No marked children at all. */
14075 die->die_child = NULL;
14076 else
14078 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
14079 die->die_child = prev;
14081 return;
14084 if (c != prev->die_sib)
14085 prev->die_sib = c;
14086 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
14087 } while (c != die->die_child);
14091 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
14093 static void
14094 prune_unused_types (void)
14096 unsigned int i;
14097 limbo_die_node *node;
14099 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14100 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
14101 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
14102 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14103 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
14104 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14106 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
14107 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14108 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14109 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14111 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14112 pubname_table or arange_table. */
14113 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
14114 prune_unused_types_mark (pubname_table[i].die, 1);
14115 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14116 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14118 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
14119 if (debug_str_hash)
14120 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
14121 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14122 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14123 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14125 /* Leave the marks clear. */
14126 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14127 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14128 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14131 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14132 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
14134 static void
14135 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14137 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14138 dw_die_ref die = 0;
14140 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
14141 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
14142 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14143 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14144 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14145 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14147 size_t i;
14148 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
14149 if (VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR
14150 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
14151 && VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != '<')
14153 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14154 break;
14158 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
14159 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14160 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14161 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14162 instance. */
14163 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14165 next_node = node->next;
14166 die = node->die;
14168 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14170 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14172 if (origin)
14173 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14174 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14176 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14177 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
14178 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14179 else
14181 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14182 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14183 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
14184 with the return type of that nested function. Force
14185 this to be a child of the containing function.
14187 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14188 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
14189 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
14190 the function is likely unreachable too. */
14191 tree context = NULL_TREE;
14193 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14195 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14196 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14197 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14198 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14200 gcc_assert (context && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL);
14202 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14203 if (origin)
14204 add_child_die (origin, die);
14205 else
14206 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14211 limbo_die_list = NULL;
14213 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14214 emit full debugging info for them. */
14215 retry_incomplete_types ();
14217 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14218 prune_unused_types ();
14220 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14221 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
14222 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14223 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14225 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14226 that have children. */
14227 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14228 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14229 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14231 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
14232 switch_to_section (text_section);
14233 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14234 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14236 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14237 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14240 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
14241 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
14242 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14243 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14244 examining the file. */
14245 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14247 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14248 output_line_info ();
14251 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14252 in .text. */
14253 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14255 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14256 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14259 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14260 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
14261 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14262 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14264 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
14265 if (have_location_lists)
14267 /* Output the location lists info. */
14268 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14269 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14270 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14271 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14272 output_location_lists (die);
14275 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14276 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14277 debug_line_section_label);
14279 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14280 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14282 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
14283 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
14284 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14285 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14287 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14289 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
14290 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14291 output_abbrev_section ();
14293 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
14294 if (pubname_table_in_use)
14296 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14297 output_pubnames ();
14300 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
14301 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
14302 if (fde_table_in_use)
14304 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14305 output_aranges ();
14308 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
14309 if (ranges_table_in_use)
14311 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14312 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14313 output_ranges ();
14316 /* Have to end the macro section. */
14317 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14319 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14320 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14323 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14324 table too. */
14325 if (debug_str_hash)
14326 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14328 #else
14330 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
14331 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14333 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14335 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"